1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger. 2 3 Copyright (C) 1992-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 4 5 This file is part of GDB. 6 7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify 8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by 9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or 10 (at your option) any later version. 11 12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, 13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of 14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the 15 GNU General Public License for more details. 16 17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License 18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ 19 20 21 #include "defs.h" 22 #include <ctype.h> 23 #include "demangle.h" 24 #include "gdb_regex.h" 25 #include "frame.h" 26 #include "symtab.h" 27 #include "gdbtypes.h" 28 #include "gdbcmd.h" 29 #include "expression.h" 30 #include "parser-defs.h" 31 #include "language.h" 32 #include "varobj.h" 33 #include "c-lang.h" 34 #include "inferior.h" 35 #include "symfile.h" 36 #include "objfiles.h" 37 #include "breakpoint.h" 38 #include "gdbcore.h" 39 #include "hashtab.h" 40 #include "gdb_obstack.h" 41 #include "ada-lang.h" 42 #include "completer.h" 43 #include <sys/stat.h> 44 #include "ui-out.h" 45 #include "block.h" 46 #include "infcall.h" 47 #include "dictionary.h" 48 #include "annotate.h" 49 #include "valprint.h" 50 #include "source.h" 51 #include "observer.h" 52 #include "vec.h" 53 #include "stack.h" 54 #include "gdb_vecs.h" 55 #include "typeprint.h" 56 #include "namespace.h" 57 58 #include "psymtab.h" 59 #include "value.h" 60 #include "mi/mi-common.h" 61 #include "arch-utils.h" 62 #include "cli/cli-utils.h" 63 #include "common/function-view.h" 64 65 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for 66 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C). 67 Copied from valarith.c. */ 68 69 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO 70 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2) 71 #endif 72 73 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *); 74 75 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *); 76 77 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *); 78 79 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *); 80 81 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *); 82 83 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *); 84 85 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *); 86 87 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *); 88 89 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *); 90 91 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int); 92 93 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int); 94 95 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int); 96 97 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int); 98 99 static int desc_arity (struct type *); 100 101 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int); 102 103 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int); 104 105 static int full_match (const char *, const char *); 106 107 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *); 108 109 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *, 110 const struct block *, const char *, 111 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int); 112 113 static void ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *, const struct block *, 114 const char *, domain_enum, int, int *); 115 116 static int is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol *, int); 117 118 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *, 119 const struct block *); 120 121 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *); 122 123 static struct block_symbol *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int); 124 125 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int, 126 struct type *); 127 128 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int, 129 struct symbol *, const struct block *); 130 131 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **); 132 133 static const char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode); 134 135 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode); 136 137 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *); 138 139 static int integer_type_p (struct type *); 140 141 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *); 142 143 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *); 144 145 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *, 146 const char **, 147 int *, 148 const char **); 149 150 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *, 151 const struct block *); 152 153 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, const char *, 154 int, int, int *); 155 156 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *); 157 158 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *, 159 const char *); 160 161 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int); 162 163 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *, 164 const gdb_byte *, 165 CORE_ADDR, struct value *); 166 167 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int); 168 169 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *); 170 171 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *); 172 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type); 173 174 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *); 175 176 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *); 177 178 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *); 179 180 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *); 181 182 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *); 183 184 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *); 185 186 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *); 187 188 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int, 189 struct value **); 190 191 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int); 192 193 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *, 194 struct type *); 195 196 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *); 197 198 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *); 199 200 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *); 201 202 static int is_name_suffix (const char *); 203 204 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int); 205 206 static int wild_match (const char *, const char *); 207 208 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *); 209 210 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *); 211 212 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *); 213 214 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *); 215 216 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *, 217 domain_enum); 218 219 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (const char *, struct value *, int, 220 struct type *); 221 222 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int, 223 struct type *); 224 225 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int, 226 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *); 227 228 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR, 229 struct value *); 230 231 static int ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol *, int, 232 struct value **, int, const char *, 233 struct type *); 234 235 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *); 236 237 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *, 238 struct language_arch_info *); 239 240 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int, 241 struct type *); 242 243 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *, 244 struct expression *, 245 int *, enum noside); 246 247 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *, 248 struct expression *, 249 int *, LONGEST *, int *, 250 int, LONGEST, LONGEST); 251 252 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *, 253 struct expression *, 254 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int, 255 LONGEST, LONGEST); 256 257 258 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *, 259 struct expression *, 260 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST); 261 262 263 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int); 264 265 266 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *, 267 int *, enum noside); 268 269 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *, 270 int *); 271 272 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name); 273 274 275 /* The result of a symbol lookup to be stored in our symbol cache. */ 276 277 struct cache_entry 278 { 279 /* The name used to perform the lookup. */ 280 const char *name; 281 /* The namespace used during the lookup. */ 282 domain_enum domain; 283 /* The symbol returned by the lookup, or NULL if no matching symbol 284 was found. */ 285 struct symbol *sym; 286 /* The block where the symbol was found, or NULL if no matching 287 symbol was found. */ 288 const struct block *block; 289 /* A pointer to the next entry with the same hash. */ 290 struct cache_entry *next; 291 }; 292 293 /* The Ada symbol cache, used to store the result of Ada-mode symbol 294 lookups in the course of executing the user's commands. 295 296 The cache is implemented using a simple, fixed-sized hash. 297 The size is fixed on the grounds that there are not likely to be 298 all that many symbols looked up during any given session, regardless 299 of the size of the symbol table. If we decide to go to a resizable 300 table, let's just use the stuff from libiberty instead. */ 301 302 #define HASH_SIZE 1009 303 304 struct ada_symbol_cache 305 { 306 /* An obstack used to store the entries in our cache. */ 307 struct obstack cache_space; 308 309 /* The root of the hash table used to implement our symbol cache. */ 310 struct cache_entry *root[HASH_SIZE]; 311 }; 312 313 static void ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache); 314 315 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */ 316 static unsigned int varsize_limit; 317 318 static const char ada_completer_word_break_characters[] = 319 #ifdef VMS 320 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-"; 321 #else 322 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-"; 323 #endif 324 325 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */ 326 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[] 327 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name"; 328 329 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */ 330 static int warning_limit = 2; 331 332 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after 333 expression evaluation. */ 334 static int warnings_issued = 0; 335 336 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = { 337 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL 338 }; 339 340 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = { 341 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL 342 }; 343 344 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */ 345 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack; 346 347 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */ 348 349 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist; 350 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist; 351 352 /* Implement the "maintenance set ada" (prefix) command. */ 353 354 static void 355 maint_set_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty) 356 { 357 help_list (maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ", all_commands, 358 gdb_stdout); 359 } 360 361 /* Implement the "maintenance show ada" (prefix) command. */ 362 363 static void 364 maint_show_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty) 365 { 366 cmd_show_list (maint_show_ada_cmdlist, from_tty, ""); 367 } 368 369 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */ 370 371 static int ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = 0; 372 373 /* Inferior-specific data. */ 374 375 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */ 376 377 struct ada_inferior_data 378 { 379 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding 380 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly 381 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this 382 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */ 383 struct type *tsd_type; 384 385 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine 386 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given 387 inferior. */ 388 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info; 389 }; 390 391 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */ 392 static const struct inferior_data *ada_inferior_data; 393 394 /* A cleanup routine for our inferior data. */ 395 static void 396 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg) 397 { 398 struct ada_inferior_data *data; 399 400 data = (struct ada_inferior_data *) inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data); 401 if (data != NULL) 402 xfree (data); 403 } 404 405 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF). 406 407 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated 408 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not 409 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all 410 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns 411 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */ 412 413 static struct ada_inferior_data * 414 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf) 415 { 416 struct ada_inferior_data *data; 417 418 data = (struct ada_inferior_data *) inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data); 419 if (data == NULL) 420 { 421 data = XCNEW (struct ada_inferior_data); 422 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, data); 423 } 424 425 return data; 426 } 427 428 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data 429 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */ 430 431 static void 432 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf) 433 { 434 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (inf, NULL); 435 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, NULL); 436 } 437 438 439 /* program-space-specific data. */ 440 441 /* This module's per-program-space data. */ 442 struct ada_pspace_data 443 { 444 /* The Ada symbol cache. */ 445 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache; 446 }; 447 448 /* Key to our per-program-space data. */ 449 static const struct program_space_data *ada_pspace_data_handle; 450 451 /* Return this module's data for the given program space (PSPACE). 452 If not is found, add a zero'ed one now. 453 454 This function always returns a valid object. */ 455 456 static struct ada_pspace_data * 457 get_ada_pspace_data (struct program_space *pspace) 458 { 459 struct ada_pspace_data *data; 460 461 data = ((struct ada_pspace_data *) 462 program_space_data (pspace, ada_pspace_data_handle)); 463 if (data == NULL) 464 { 465 data = XCNEW (struct ada_pspace_data); 466 set_program_space_data (pspace, ada_pspace_data_handle, data); 467 } 468 469 return data; 470 } 471 472 /* The cleanup callback for this module's per-program-space data. */ 473 474 static void 475 ada_pspace_data_cleanup (struct program_space *pspace, void *data) 476 { 477 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = (struct ada_pspace_data *) data; 478 479 if (pspace_data->sym_cache != NULL) 480 ada_free_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache); 481 xfree (pspace_data); 482 } 483 484 /* Utilities */ 485 486 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after 487 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE. 488 489 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer. 490 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be 491 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because 492 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction. 493 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many 494 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally 495 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain 496 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding). 497 498 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information 499 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For 500 instance, consider the following example with stabs: 501 502 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...] 503 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0 504 505 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type 506 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time, 507 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef. 508 509 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is 510 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these 511 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */ 512 513 static struct type * 514 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type) 515 { 516 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 517 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 518 return type; 519 } 520 521 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its 522 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns 523 its unqualified name. */ 524 525 static const char * 526 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name) 527 { 528 const char *result; 529 530 /* If the decoded name starts with '<', it means that the encoded 531 name does not follow standard naming conventions, and thus that 532 it is not your typical Ada symbol name. Trying to unqualify it 533 is therefore pointless and possibly erroneous. */ 534 if (decoded_name[0] == '<') 535 return decoded_name; 536 537 result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.'); 538 if (result != NULL) 539 result++; /* Skip the dot... */ 540 else 541 result = decoded_name; 542 543 return result; 544 } 545 546 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'. 547 The result is good until the next call. */ 548 549 static char * 550 add_angle_brackets (const char *str) 551 { 552 static char *result = NULL; 553 554 xfree (result); 555 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str); 556 return result; 557 } 558 559 static const char * 560 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void) 561 { 562 return ada_completer_word_break_characters; 563 } 564 565 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */ 566 567 static void 568 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream, 569 const struct value_print_options *options) 570 { 571 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options); 572 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => "); 573 } 574 575 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size 576 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects, 577 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */ 578 579 void * 580 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size) 581 { 582 if (*size < min_size) 583 { 584 *size *= 2; 585 if (*size < min_size) 586 *size = min_size; 587 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size); 588 } 589 return vect; 590 } 591 592 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing 593 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */ 594 595 static int 596 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target) 597 { 598 int len = strlen (target); 599 600 return 601 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0 602 && (field_name[len] == '\0' 603 || (startswith (field_name + len, "___") 604 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6, 605 "___XVN") != 0))); 606 } 607 608 609 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to 610 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME, 611 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name 612 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name 613 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints. 614 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if 615 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */ 616 617 int 618 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name, 619 int maybe_missing) 620 { 621 int fieldno; 622 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type); 623 624 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++) 625 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name)) 626 return fieldno; 627 628 if (!maybe_missing) 629 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"), 630 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type)); 631 632 return -1; 633 } 634 635 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */ 636 637 int 638 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name) 639 { 640 if (name == NULL) 641 return 0; 642 else 643 { 644 const char *p = strstr (name, "___"); 645 646 if (p == NULL) 647 return strlen (name); 648 else 649 return p - name; 650 } 651 } 652 653 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR. 654 Return zero if STR is null. */ 655 656 static int 657 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix) 658 { 659 int len1, len2; 660 661 if (str == NULL) 662 return 0; 663 len1 = strlen (str); 664 len2 = strlen (suffix); 665 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0); 666 } 667 668 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The 669 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */ 670 671 static struct value * 672 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type) 673 { 674 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 675 if (value_type (val) == type) 676 return val; 677 else 678 { 679 struct value *result; 680 681 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before 682 trying to allocate some memory for it. */ 683 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type); 684 685 if (value_lazy (val) 686 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val))) 687 result = allocate_value_lazy (type); 688 else 689 { 690 result = allocate_value (type); 691 value_contents_copy_raw (result, 0, val, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 692 } 693 set_value_component_location (result, val); 694 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val)); 695 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val)); 696 set_value_address (result, value_address (val)); 697 return result; 698 } 699 } 700 701 static const gdb_byte * 702 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset) 703 { 704 if (valaddr == NULL) 705 return NULL; 706 else 707 return valaddr + offset; 708 } 709 710 static CORE_ADDR 711 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset) 712 { 713 if (address == 0) 714 return 0; 715 else 716 return address + offset; 717 } 718 719 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but 720 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the 721 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current 722 expression. */ 723 724 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior 725 provided by "complaint". */ 726 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2); 727 728 static void 729 lim_warning (const char *format, ...) 730 { 731 va_list args; 732 733 va_start (args, format); 734 warnings_issued += 1; 735 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit) 736 vwarning (format, args); 737 738 va_end (args); 739 } 740 741 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable, 742 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in 743 GDB. */ 744 745 void 746 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (const struct type *type) 747 { 748 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit) 749 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit")); 750 } 751 752 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */ 753 static LONGEST 754 max_of_size (int size) 755 { 756 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2); 757 758 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1); 759 } 760 761 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */ 762 static LONGEST 763 min_of_size (int size) 764 { 765 return -max_of_size (size) - 1; 766 } 767 768 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */ 769 static ULONGEST 770 umax_of_size (int size) 771 { 772 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1); 773 774 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1); 775 } 776 777 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */ 778 static LONGEST 779 max_of_type (struct type *t) 780 { 781 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)) 782 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t)); 783 else 784 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t)); 785 } 786 787 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */ 788 static LONGEST 789 min_of_type (struct type *t) 790 { 791 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)) 792 return 0; 793 else 794 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t)); 795 } 796 797 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */ 798 LONGEST 799 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type) 800 { 801 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, NULL, 0); 802 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 803 { 804 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 805 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type); 806 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 807 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1); 808 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL: 809 return 1; 810 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR: 811 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 812 return max_of_type (type); 813 default: 814 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound.")); 815 } 816 } 817 818 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */ 819 LONGEST 820 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type) 821 { 822 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, NULL, 0); 823 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 824 { 825 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 826 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type); 827 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 828 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0); 829 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL: 830 return 0; 831 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR: 832 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 833 return min_of_type (type); 834 default: 835 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound.")); 836 } 837 } 838 839 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying 840 non-range scalar type. */ 841 842 static struct type * 843 get_base_type (struct type *type) 844 { 845 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) 846 { 847 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL) 848 return type; 849 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 850 } 851 return type; 852 } 853 854 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning 855 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific 856 encondings, making the resulting type a static but standard description 857 of the initial type. */ 858 859 struct value * 860 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value) 861 { 862 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value)); 863 864 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type) 865 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type) 866 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)) 867 { 868 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */ 869 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value); 870 else 871 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value); 872 } 873 else 874 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value); 875 876 return value; 877 } 878 879 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE. 880 Because there is no associated actual value for this type, 881 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in 882 the case of dynamic types. */ 883 884 struct type * 885 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type) 886 { 887 type = to_static_fixed_type (type); 888 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)) 889 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type); 890 return type; 891 } 892 893 894 895 /* Language Selection */ 896 897 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG 898 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */ 899 900 enum language 901 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang) 902 { 903 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL, 904 (struct objfile *) NULL).minsym != NULL) 905 return language_ada; 906 907 return lang; 908 } 909 910 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name. 911 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main 912 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */ 913 914 char * 915 ada_main_name (void) 916 { 917 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym; 918 static char *main_program_name = NULL; 919 920 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific 921 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol, 922 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find 923 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written 924 in Ada. */ 925 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL); 926 927 if (msym.minsym != NULL) 928 { 929 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr; 930 int err_code; 931 932 main_program_name_addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym); 933 if (main_program_name_addr == 0) 934 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name.")); 935 936 xfree (main_program_name); 937 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name, 938 1024, &err_code); 939 940 if (err_code != 0) 941 return NULL; 942 return main_program_name; 943 } 944 945 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */ 946 return NULL; 947 } 948 949 /* Symbols */ 950 951 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair 952 of NULLs. */ 953 954 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = { 955 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD}, 956 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB}, 957 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL}, 958 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV}, 959 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD}, 960 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM}, 961 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP}, 962 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS}, 963 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ}, 964 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR}, 965 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ}, 966 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL}, 967 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL}, 968 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND}, 969 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR}, 970 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR}, 971 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT}, 972 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS}, 973 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT}, 974 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS}, 975 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG}, 976 {NULL, NULL} 977 }; 978 979 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions. 980 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */ 981 982 char * 983 ada_encode (const char *decoded) 984 { 985 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL; 986 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0; 987 const char *p; 988 int k; 989 990 if (decoded == NULL) 991 return NULL; 992 993 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size, 994 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10); 995 996 k = 0; 997 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1) 998 { 999 if (*p == '.') 1000 { 1001 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_'; 1002 k += 2; 1003 } 1004 else if (*p == '"') 1005 { 1006 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping; 1007 1008 for (mapping = ada_opname_table; 1009 mapping->encoded != NULL 1010 && !startswith (p, mapping->decoded); mapping += 1) 1011 ; 1012 if (mapping->encoded == NULL) 1013 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p); 1014 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded); 1015 k += strlen (mapping->encoded); 1016 break; 1017 } 1018 else 1019 { 1020 encoding_buffer[k] = *p; 1021 k += 1; 1022 } 1023 } 1024 1025 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0'; 1026 return encoding_buffer; 1027 } 1028 1029 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single 1030 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good 1031 to next call. */ 1032 1033 char * 1034 ada_fold_name (const char *name) 1035 { 1036 static char *fold_buffer = NULL; 1037 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0; 1038 1039 int len = strlen (name); 1040 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1); 1041 1042 if (name[0] == '\'') 1043 { 1044 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2); 1045 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000'; 1046 } 1047 else 1048 { 1049 int i; 1050 1051 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1) 1052 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]); 1053 } 1054 1055 return fold_buffer; 1056 } 1057 1058 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */ 1059 1060 static int 1061 is_lower_alphanum (const char c) 1062 { 1063 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c))); 1064 } 1065 1066 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length. 1067 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but 1068 without either of these suffixes: 1069 . .{DIGIT}+ 1070 . ${DIGIT}+ 1071 . ___{DIGIT}+ 1072 . __{DIGIT}+. 1073 1074 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as 1075 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes. 1076 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */ 1077 1078 static void 1079 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len) 1080 { 1081 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1])) 1082 { 1083 int i = *len - 2; 1084 1085 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i])) 1086 i--; 1087 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.') 1088 *len = i; 1089 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$') 1090 *len = i; 1091 else if (i >= 2 && startswith (encoded + i - 2, "___")) 1092 *len = i - 2; 1093 else if (i >= 1 && startswith (encoded + i - 1, "__")) 1094 *len = i - 1; 1095 } 1096 } 1097 1098 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object 1099 subprograms. */ 1100 1101 static void 1102 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len) 1103 { 1104 /* Remove trailing N. */ 1105 1106 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two 1107 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has 1108 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has 1109 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling 1110 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated, 1111 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this 1112 entity is internal. */ 1113 1114 if (*len > 1 1115 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N' 1116 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2]))) 1117 *len = *len - 1; 1118 } 1119 1120 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */ 1121 1122 static void 1123 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len) 1124 { 1125 int i = *len - 1; 1126 1127 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n')) 1128 i--; 1129 1130 if (encoded[i] != 'X') 1131 return; 1132 1133 if (i == 0) 1134 return; 1135 1136 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1])) 1137 *len = i; 1138 } 1139 1140 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return 1141 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is 1142 replaced by ENCODED. 1143 1144 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode. 1145 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer 1146 is returned. */ 1147 1148 const char * 1149 ada_decode (const char *encoded) 1150 { 1151 int i, j; 1152 int len0; 1153 const char *p; 1154 char *decoded; 1155 int at_start_name; 1156 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL; 1157 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0; 1158 1159 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_". 1160 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part 1161 if we see this prefix. */ 1162 if (startswith (encoded, "_ada_")) 1163 encoded += 5; 1164 1165 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded 1166 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name 1167 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */ 1168 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<') 1169 goto Suppress; 1170 1171 len0 = strlen (encoded); 1172 1173 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0); 1174 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0); 1175 1176 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that 1177 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want 1178 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been 1179 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */ 1180 p = strstr (encoded, "___"); 1181 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3) 1182 { 1183 if (p[3] == 'X') 1184 len0 = p - encoded; 1185 else 1186 goto Suppress; 1187 } 1188 1189 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol 1190 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually 1191 appear in the decoded name. */ 1192 1193 if (len0 > 3 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB")) 1194 len0 -= 3; 1195 1196 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different 1197 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task 1198 bodies. */ 1199 1200 if (len0 > 2 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB")) 1201 len0 -= 2; 1202 1203 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */ 1204 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */ 1205 1206 if (len0 > 1 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 1, "B")) 1207 len0 -= 1; 1208 1209 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */ 1210 1211 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1); 1212 decoded = decoding_buffer; 1213 1214 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */ 1215 1216 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1])) 1217 { 1218 i = len0 - 2; 1219 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i])) 1220 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1]))) 1221 i -= 1; 1222 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_') 1223 len0 = i - 1; 1224 else if (encoded[i] == '$') 1225 len0 = i; 1226 } 1227 1228 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part 1229 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */ 1230 1231 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1) 1232 decoded[j] = encoded[i]; 1233 1234 at_start_name = 1; 1235 while (i < len0) 1236 { 1237 /* Is this a symbol function? */ 1238 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O') 1239 { 1240 int k; 1241 1242 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1) 1243 { 1244 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded); 1245 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1, 1246 op_len - 1) == 0) 1247 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len])) 1248 { 1249 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded); 1250 at_start_name = 0; 1251 i += op_len; 1252 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded); 1253 break; 1254 } 1255 } 1256 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL) 1257 continue; 1258 } 1259 at_start_name = 0; 1260 1261 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated 1262 into "." (just below). */ 1263 1264 if (i < len0 - 4 && startswith (encoded + i, "TK__")) 1265 i += 2; 1266 1267 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually 1268 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names 1269 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */ 1270 1271 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_' 1272 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_' 1273 && isdigit (encoded [i+4])) 1274 { 1275 int k = i + 5; 1276 1277 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k])) 1278 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */ 1279 1280 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found 1281 is indeed followed by "__". */ 1282 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_') 1283 i = k; 1284 } 1285 1286 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */ 1287 1288 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories 1289 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first 1290 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following 1291 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and 1292 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced 1293 by a 'B'. 1294 1295 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions 1296 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been 1297 internally generated. */ 1298 1299 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E' 1300 && isdigit (encoded[i+2])) 1301 { 1302 int k = i + 3; 1303 1304 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k])) 1305 k++; 1306 1307 if (k < len0 1308 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's')) 1309 { 1310 k++; 1311 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this 1312 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'. 1313 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */ 1314 if (k == len0 1315 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_')) 1316 i = k; 1317 } 1318 } 1319 1320 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by 1321 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */ 1322 1323 if (i < len0 + 3 1324 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_') 1325 { 1326 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of 1327 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find 1328 digits or lowercase characters. */ 1329 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1; 1330 1331 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0])) 1332 ptr--; 1333 if (ptr < encoded 1334 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_')) 1335 i++; 1336 } 1337 1338 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1])) 1339 { 1340 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous 1341 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other 1342 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then 1343 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If 1344 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the 1345 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested 1346 package names. */ 1347 do 1348 i += 1; 1349 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n')); 1350 if (i < len0) 1351 goto Suppress; 1352 } 1353 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_') 1354 { 1355 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */ 1356 decoded[j] = '.'; 1357 at_start_name = 1; 1358 i += 2; 1359 j += 1; 1360 } 1361 else 1362 { 1363 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it 1364 over. */ 1365 decoded[j] = encoded[i]; 1366 i += 1; 1367 j += 1; 1368 } 1369 } 1370 decoded[j] = '\000'; 1371 1372 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character. 1373 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */ 1374 1375 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1) 1376 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ') 1377 goto Suppress; 1378 1379 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0) 1380 return encoded; 1381 else 1382 return decoded; 1383 1384 Suppress: 1385 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3); 1386 decoded = decoding_buffer; 1387 if (encoded[0] == '<') 1388 strcpy (decoded, encoded); 1389 else 1390 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded); 1391 return decoded; 1392 1393 } 1394 1395 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once 1396 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a 1397 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive 1398 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a 1399 symbol table loaded during a single session. */ 1400 static struct htab *decoded_names_store; 1401 1402 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it 1403 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been 1404 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same 1405 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that, 1406 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of 1407 GSYMBOL). 1408 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically 1409 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form 1410 when a decoded name is cached in it. */ 1411 1412 const char * 1413 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg) 1414 { 1415 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg; 1416 const char **resultp = 1417 &gsymbol->language_specific.demangled_name; 1418 1419 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled) 1420 { 1421 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name); 1422 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack; 1423 1424 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1; 1425 1426 if (obstack != NULL) 1427 *resultp 1428 = (const char *) obstack_copy0 (obstack, decoded, strlen (decoded)); 1429 else 1430 { 1431 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in 1432 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only 1433 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a 1434 significant memory leak (FIXME). */ 1435 1436 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store, 1437 decoded, INSERT); 1438 1439 if (*slot == NULL) 1440 *slot = xstrdup (decoded); 1441 *resultp = *slot; 1442 } 1443 } 1444 1445 return *resultp; 1446 } 1447 1448 static char * 1449 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options) 1450 { 1451 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded)); 1452 } 1453 1454 /* Implement la_sniff_from_mangled_name for Ada. */ 1455 1456 static int 1457 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name (const char *mangled, char **out) 1458 { 1459 const char *demangled = ada_decode (mangled); 1460 1461 *out = NULL; 1462 1463 if (demangled != mangled && demangled != NULL && demangled[0] != '<') 1464 { 1465 /* Set the gsymbol language to Ada, but still return 0. 1466 Two reasons for that: 1467 1468 1. For Ada, we prefer computing the symbol's decoded name 1469 on the fly rather than pre-compute it, in order to save 1470 memory (Ada projects are typically very large). 1471 1472 2. There are some areas in the definition of the GNAT 1473 encoding where, with a bit of bad luck, we might be able 1474 to decode a non-Ada symbol, generating an incorrect 1475 demangled name (Eg: names ending with "TB" for instance 1476 are identified as task bodies and so stripped from 1477 the decoded name returned). 1478 1479 Returning 1, here, but not setting *DEMANGLED, helps us get a 1480 little bit of the best of both worlds. Because we're last, 1481 we should not affect any of the other languages that were 1482 able to demangle the symbol before us; we get to correctly 1483 tag Ada symbols as such; and even if we incorrectly tagged a 1484 non-Ada symbol, which should be rare, any routing through the 1485 Ada language should be transparent (Ada tries to behave much 1486 like C/C++ with non-Ada symbols). */ 1487 return 1; 1488 } 1489 1490 return 0; 1491 } 1492 1493 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing 1494 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on 1495 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging 1496 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a 1497 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if 1498 either argument is NULL. */ 1499 1500 static int 1501 match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild) 1502 { 1503 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL) 1504 return 0; 1505 else if (wild) 1506 return wild_match (sym_name, name) == 0; 1507 else 1508 { 1509 int len_name = strlen (name); 1510 1511 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0 1512 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name)) 1513 || (startswith (sym_name, "_ada_") 1514 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0 1515 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5)); 1516 } 1517 } 1518 1519 1520 /* Arrays */ 1521 1522 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure 1523 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used 1524 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest 1525 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding. 1526 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if 1527 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL. 1528 1529 The GNAT encoding used to describle the array index type evolved a bit. 1530 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each 1531 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was 1532 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected 1533 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order 1534 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global 1535 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make 1536 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being 1537 the full index type description. 1538 1539 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions 1540 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by 1541 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point, 1542 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated 1543 index subtype). */ 1544 1545 void 1546 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type) 1547 { 1548 int i; 1549 1550 if (index_desc_type == NULL) 1551 return; 1552 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0); 1553 1554 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient 1555 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return 1556 now. 1557 1558 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding, 1559 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name 1560 is not equal to the field name. */ 1561 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL 1562 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)), 1563 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0) 1564 return; 1565 1566 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */ 1567 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++) 1568 { 1569 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i); 1570 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name)); 1571 1572 if (raw_type) 1573 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type; 1574 } 1575 } 1576 1577 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */ 1578 1579 static const char *bound_name[] = { 1580 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3", 1581 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7" 1582 }; 1583 1584 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */ 1585 1586 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *))) 1587 1588 1589 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors 1590 (fat pointers). */ 1591 1592 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes 1593 level of indirection, if needed. */ 1594 1595 static struct type * 1596 desc_base_type (struct type *type) 1597 { 1598 if (type == NULL) 1599 return NULL; 1600 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 1601 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 1602 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type); 1603 1604 if (type != NULL 1605 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 1606 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)) 1607 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 1608 else 1609 return type; 1610 } 1611 1612 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */ 1613 1614 static int 1615 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type) 1616 { 1617 return 1618 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT") 1619 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE"); 1620 } 1621 1622 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */ 1623 1624 static struct type * 1625 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type) 1626 { 1627 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type); 1628 1629 if (base_type == NULL) 1630 return NULL; 1631 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE")) 1632 return base_type; 1633 else 1634 { 1635 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE"); 1636 1637 if (alt_type == NULL) 1638 return base_type; 1639 else 1640 return alt_type; 1641 } 1642 } 1643 1644 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */ 1645 1646 static struct value * 1647 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val) 1648 { 1649 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)); 1650 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)); 1651 1652 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type); 1653 1654 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 1655 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val)); 1656 else 1657 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val)); 1658 } 1659 1660 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */ 1661 1662 static int 1663 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type) 1664 { 1665 type = desc_base_type (type); 1666 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 1667 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL); 1668 } 1669 1670 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a 1671 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */ 1672 1673 static struct type * 1674 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type) 1675 { 1676 struct type *r; 1677 1678 type = desc_base_type (type); 1679 1680 if (type == NULL) 1681 return NULL; 1682 else if (is_thin_pntr (type)) 1683 { 1684 type = thin_descriptor_type (type); 1685 if (type == NULL) 1686 return NULL; 1687 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1); 1688 if (r != NULL) 1689 return ada_check_typedef (r); 1690 } 1691 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 1692 { 1693 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1); 1694 if (r != NULL) 1695 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r))); 1696 } 1697 return NULL; 1698 } 1699 1700 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to 1701 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */ 1702 1703 static struct value * 1704 desc_bounds (struct value *arr) 1705 { 1706 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)); 1707 1708 if (is_thin_pntr (type)) 1709 { 1710 struct type *bounds_type = 1711 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)); 1712 LONGEST addr; 1713 1714 if (bounds_type == NULL) 1715 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor")); 1716 1717 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but 1718 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be), 1719 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */ 1720 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 1721 addr = value_as_long (arr); 1722 else 1723 addr = value_address (arr); 1724 1725 return 1726 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type), 1727 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type)); 1728 } 1729 1730 else if (is_thick_pntr (type)) 1731 { 1732 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL, 1733 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor")); 1734 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds); 1735 1736 if (p_bounds_type 1737 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 1738 { 1739 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type); 1740 1741 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type)) 1742 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type 1743 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)), 1744 p_bounds); 1745 } 1746 else 1747 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor")); 1748 1749 return p_bounds; 1750 } 1751 else 1752 return NULL; 1753 } 1754 1755 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit 1756 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */ 1757 1758 static int 1759 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type) 1760 { 1761 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1); 1762 } 1763 1764 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit 1765 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */ 1766 1767 static int 1768 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type) 1769 { 1770 type = desc_base_type (type); 1771 1772 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0) 1773 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1); 1774 else 1775 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1))); 1776 } 1777 1778 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a 1779 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type); 1780 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds 1781 data. */ 1782 1783 static struct type * 1784 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type) 1785 { 1786 type = desc_base_type (type); 1787 1788 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */ 1789 if (is_thin_pntr (type)) 1790 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1)); 1791 else if (is_thick_pntr (type)) 1792 { 1793 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1); 1794 1795 if (data_type 1796 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 1797 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type)); 1798 } 1799 1800 return NULL; 1801 } 1802 1803 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to 1804 its array data. */ 1805 1806 static struct value * 1807 desc_data (struct value *arr) 1808 { 1809 struct type *type = value_type (arr); 1810 1811 if (is_thin_pntr (type)) 1812 return thin_data_pntr (arr); 1813 else if (is_thick_pntr (type)) 1814 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL, 1815 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor")); 1816 else 1817 return NULL; 1818 } 1819 1820 1821 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit 1822 position of the field containing the address of the data. */ 1823 1824 static int 1825 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type) 1826 { 1827 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0); 1828 } 1829 1830 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit 1831 size of the field containing the address of the data. */ 1832 1833 static int 1834 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type) 1835 { 1836 type = desc_base_type (type); 1837 1838 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0) 1839 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0); 1840 else 1841 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0)); 1842 } 1843 1844 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return 1845 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper 1846 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */ 1847 1848 static struct value * 1849 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which) 1850 { 1851 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL, 1852 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds")); 1853 } 1854 1855 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position 1856 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper 1857 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */ 1858 1859 static int 1860 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which) 1861 { 1862 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2); 1863 } 1864 1865 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size 1866 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper 1867 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */ 1868 1869 static int 1870 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which) 1871 { 1872 type = desc_base_type (type); 1873 1874 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0) 1875 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2); 1876 else 1877 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2)); 1878 } 1879 1880 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its 1881 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */ 1882 1883 static struct type * 1884 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i) 1885 { 1886 type = desc_base_type (type); 1887 1888 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 1889 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1); 1890 else 1891 return NULL; 1892 } 1893 1894 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE. 1895 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */ 1896 1897 static int 1898 desc_arity (struct type *type) 1899 { 1900 type = desc_base_type (type); 1901 1902 if (type != NULL) 1903 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2; 1904 return 0; 1905 } 1906 1907 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or 1908 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array 1909 type). */ 1910 1911 static int 1912 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type) 1913 { 1914 if (type == NULL) 1915 return 0; 1916 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 1917 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 1918 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)); 1919 } 1920 1921 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer 1922 * to one. */ 1923 1924 static int 1925 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type) 1926 { 1927 while (type != NULL 1928 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 1929 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)) 1930 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 1931 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type); 1932 } 1933 1934 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */ 1935 1936 int 1937 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type) 1938 { 1939 if (type == NULL) 1940 return 0; 1941 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 1942 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 1943 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 1944 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))) 1945 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)); 1946 } 1947 1948 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */ 1949 1950 int 1951 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type) 1952 { 1953 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type); 1954 1955 if (type == NULL) 1956 return 0; 1957 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 1958 return (data_type != NULL 1959 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 1960 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0); 1961 } 1962 1963 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array 1964 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with 1965 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it 1966 is still needed. */ 1967 1968 int 1969 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type) 1970 { 1971 return 1972 type != NULL 1973 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 1974 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL 1975 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL) 1976 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type); 1977 } 1978 1979 1980 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor, 1981 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically, 1982 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled 1983 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If 1984 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero, 1985 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not 1986 a descriptor. */ 1987 struct type * 1988 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds) 1989 { 1990 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr))) 1991 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)); 1992 1993 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr))) 1994 return value_type (arr); 1995 1996 if (!bounds) 1997 { 1998 struct type *array_type = 1999 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr))); 2000 2001 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr))) 2002 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) = 2003 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr)); 2004 2005 return array_type; 2006 } 2007 else 2008 { 2009 struct type *elt_type; 2010 int arity; 2011 struct value *descriptor; 2012 2013 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1); 2014 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr)); 2015 2016 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0) 2017 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)); 2018 2019 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr); 2020 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0) 2021 return NULL; 2022 while (arity > 0) 2023 { 2024 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr)); 2025 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr)); 2026 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0); 2027 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1); 2028 2029 arity -= 1; 2030 create_static_range_type (range_type, value_type (low), 2031 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)), 2032 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high))); 2033 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type); 2034 2035 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr))) 2036 { 2037 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as 2038 recompute the array size, because it was previously 2039 computed based on the unpacked element size. */ 2040 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low); 2041 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high); 2042 2043 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) = 2044 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr)); 2045 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already 2046 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */ 2047 if (lo < hi) 2048 { 2049 int array_bitsize = 2050 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0); 2051 2052 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8; 2053 } 2054 } 2055 } 2056 2057 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type); 2058 } 2059 } 2060 2061 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged. 2062 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set 2063 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard 2064 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */ 2065 2066 struct value * 2067 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr) 2068 { 2069 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr))) 2070 { 2071 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1); 2072 2073 if (arrType == NULL) 2074 return NULL; 2075 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr))); 2076 } 2077 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr))) 2078 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr); 2079 else 2080 return arr; 2081 } 2082 2083 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged. 2084 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may 2085 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */ 2086 2087 struct value * 2088 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr) 2089 { 2090 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr))) 2091 { 2092 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr); 2093 2094 if (arrVal == NULL) 2095 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer.")); 2096 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal))); 2097 return value_ind (arrVal); 2098 } 2099 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr))) 2100 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr); 2101 else 2102 return arr; 2103 } 2104 2105 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an 2106 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating 2107 packing). For other types, is the identity. */ 2108 2109 struct type * 2110 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type) 2111 { 2112 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)) 2113 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type); 2114 2115 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)) 2116 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type)); 2117 2118 return type; 2119 } 2120 2121 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */ 2122 2123 static int 2124 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type) 2125 { 2126 if (type == NULL) 2127 return 0; 2128 type = desc_base_type (type); 2129 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 2130 return 2131 ada_type_name (type) != NULL 2132 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL; 2133 } 2134 2135 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained 2136 packed-array type. */ 2137 2138 int 2139 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type) 2140 { 2141 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type) 2142 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type); 2143 } 2144 2145 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a 2146 unconstrained packed-array type. */ 2147 2148 static int 2149 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type) 2150 { 2151 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type) 2152 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type); 2153 } 2154 2155 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained), 2156 return the size of its elements in bits. */ 2157 2158 static long 2159 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type) 2160 { 2161 const char *raw_name; 2162 const char *tail; 2163 long bits; 2164 2165 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef 2166 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type 2167 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */ 2168 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 2169 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type); 2170 2171 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type)); 2172 if (!raw_name) 2173 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)); 2174 2175 if (!raw_name) 2176 return 0; 2177 2178 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP"); 2179 gdb_assert (tail != NULL); 2180 2181 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1) 2182 { 2183 lim_warning 2184 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array")); 2185 return 0; 2186 } 2187 2188 return bits; 2189 } 2190 2191 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled 2192 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents 2193 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its 2194 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type, 2195 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any 2196 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its 2197 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size 2198 in bits. 2199 2200 Note that, for arrays whose index type has an XA encoding where 2201 a bound references a record discriminant, getting that discriminant, 2202 and therefore the actual value of that bound, is not possible 2203 because none of the given parameters gives us access to the record. 2204 This function assumes that it is OK in the context where it is being 2205 used to return an array whose bounds are still dynamic and where 2206 the length is arbitrary. */ 2207 2208 static struct type * 2209 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits) 2210 { 2211 struct type *new_elt_type; 2212 struct type *new_type; 2213 struct type *index_type_desc; 2214 struct type *index_type; 2215 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound; 2216 2217 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 2218 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 2219 return type; 2220 2221 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA"); 2222 if (index_type_desc) 2223 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0), 2224 NULL); 2225 else 2226 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type); 2227 2228 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type); 2229 new_elt_type = 2230 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)), 2231 elt_bits); 2232 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type); 2233 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits; 2234 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type); 2235 2236 if ((TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (index_type)) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE 2237 && is_dynamic_type (check_typedef (index_type))) 2238 || get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0) 2239 low_bound = high_bound = 0; 2240 if (high_bound < low_bound) 2241 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0; 2242 else 2243 { 2244 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1); 2245 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 2246 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2247 } 2248 2249 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1; 2250 return new_type; 2251 } 2252 2253 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where 2254 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */ 2255 2256 static struct type * 2257 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type) 2258 { 2259 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type)); 2260 char *name; 2261 const char *tail; 2262 struct type *shadow_type; 2263 long bits; 2264 2265 if (!raw_name) 2266 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)); 2267 2268 if (!raw_name) 2269 return NULL; 2270 2271 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1); 2272 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP"); 2273 type = desc_base_type (type); 2274 2275 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name); 2276 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000'; 2277 2278 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name); 2279 2280 if (shadow_type == NULL) 2281 { 2282 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array")); 2283 return NULL; 2284 } 2285 shadow_type = check_typedef (shadow_type); 2286 2287 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 2288 { 2289 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds " 2290 "information on packed array")); 2291 return NULL; 2292 } 2293 2294 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type); 2295 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits); 2296 } 2297 2298 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed 2299 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a 2300 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array 2301 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the 2302 type length is set appropriately. */ 2303 2304 static struct value * 2305 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr) 2306 { 2307 struct type *type; 2308 2309 /* If our value is a pointer, then dereference it. Likewise if 2310 the value is a reference. Make sure that this operation does not 2311 cause the target type to be fixed, as this would indirectly cause 2312 this array to be decoded. The rest of the routine assumes that 2313 the array hasn't been decoded yet, so we use the basic "coerce_ref" 2314 and "value_ind" routines to perform the dereferencing, as opposed 2315 to using "ada_coerce_ref" or "ada_value_ind". */ 2316 arr = coerce_ref (arr); 2317 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 2318 arr = value_ind (arr); 2319 2320 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)); 2321 if (type == NULL) 2322 { 2323 error (_("can't unpack array")); 2324 return NULL; 2325 } 2326 2327 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr))) 2328 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr))) 2329 { 2330 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed 2331 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through 2332 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must 2333 first left-justify it. */ 2334 int bit_size, bit_pos; 2335 ULONGEST mod; 2336 2337 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1; 2338 bit_size = 0; 2339 while (mod > 0) 2340 { 2341 bit_size += 1; 2342 mod >>= 1; 2343 } 2344 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size; 2345 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, 2346 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT, 2347 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT, 2348 bit_size, 2349 type); 2350 } 2351 2352 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type); 2353 } 2354 2355 2356 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices 2357 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */ 2358 2359 static struct value * 2360 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind) 2361 { 2362 int i; 2363 int bits, elt_off, bit_off; 2364 long elt_total_bit_offset; 2365 struct type *elt_type; 2366 struct value *v; 2367 2368 bits = 0; 2369 elt_total_bit_offset = 0; 2370 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)); 2371 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1) 2372 { 2373 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 2374 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0) 2375 error 2376 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of " 2377 "something other than a packed array")); 2378 else 2379 { 2380 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type); 2381 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound; 2382 LONGEST idx; 2383 2384 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0) 2385 { 2386 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array")); 2387 lowerbound = upperbound = 0; 2388 } 2389 2390 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]); 2391 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound) 2392 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"), 2393 (long) idx); 2394 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0); 2395 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits; 2396 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type)); 2397 } 2398 } 2399 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2400 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2401 2402 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off, 2403 bits, elt_type); 2404 return v; 2405 } 2406 2407 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */ 2408 2409 static int 2410 has_negatives (struct type *type) 2411 { 2412 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 2413 { 2414 default: 2415 return 0; 2416 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 2417 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type); 2418 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 2419 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0; 2420 } 2421 } 2422 2423 /* With SRC being a buffer containing BIT_SIZE bits of data at BIT_OFFSET, 2424 unpack that data into UNPACKED. UNPACKED_LEN is the size in bytes of 2425 the unpacked buffer. 2426 2427 The size of the unpacked buffer (UNPACKED_LEN) is expected to be large 2428 enough to contain at least BIT_OFFSET bits. If not, an error is raised. 2429 2430 IS_BIG_ENDIAN is nonzero if the data is stored in big endian mode, 2431 zero otherwise. 2432 2433 IS_SIGNED_TYPE is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type. 2434 2435 IS_SCALAR is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type. */ 2436 2437 static void 2438 ada_unpack_from_contents (const gdb_byte *src, int bit_offset, int bit_size, 2439 gdb_byte *unpacked, int unpacked_len, 2440 int is_big_endian, int is_signed_type, 2441 int is_scalar) 2442 { 2443 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8; 2444 int src_idx; /* Index into the source area */ 2445 int src_bytes_left; /* Number of source bytes left to process. */ 2446 int srcBitsLeft; /* Number of source bits left to move */ 2447 int unusedLS; /* Number of bits in next significant 2448 byte of source that are unused */ 2449 2450 int unpacked_idx; /* Index into the unpacked buffer */ 2451 int unpacked_bytes_left; /* Number of bytes left to set in unpacked. */ 2452 2453 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */ 2454 int accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */ 2455 unsigned char sign; 2456 2457 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction 2458 the indices move. */ 2459 int delta = is_big_endian ? -1 : 1; 2460 2461 /* Make sure that unpacked is large enough to receive the BIT_SIZE 2462 bits from SRC. .*/ 2463 if ((bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT > unpacked_len) 2464 error (_("Cannot unpack %d bits into buffer of %d bytes"), 2465 bit_size, unpacked_len); 2466 2467 srcBitsLeft = bit_size; 2468 src_bytes_left = src_len; 2469 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_len; 2470 sign = 0; 2471 2472 if (is_big_endian) 2473 { 2474 src_idx = src_len - 1; 2475 if (is_signed_type 2476 && ((src[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1)))) 2477 sign = ~0; 2478 2479 unusedLS = 2480 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT) 2481 % HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2482 2483 if (is_scalar) 2484 { 2485 accumSize = 0; 2486 unpacked_idx = unpacked_len - 1; 2487 } 2488 else 2489 { 2490 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */ 2491 accumSize = 2492 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2493 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes 2494 of the target. */ 2495 unpacked_idx = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1; 2496 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_idx + 1; 2497 } 2498 } 2499 else 2500 { 2501 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8; 2502 2503 src_idx = unpacked_idx = 0; 2504 unusedLS = bit_offset; 2505 accumSize = 0; 2506 2507 if (is_signed_type && (src[src_len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset))) 2508 sign = ~0; 2509 } 2510 2511 accum = 0; 2512 while (src_bytes_left > 0) 2513 { 2514 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not 2515 part of the value. */ 2516 unsigned int unusedMSMask = 2517 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) - 2518 1; 2519 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */ 2520 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask; 2521 2522 accum |= 2523 (((src[src_idx] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize; 2524 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS; 2525 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT) 2526 { 2527 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT); 2528 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2529 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2530 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1; 2531 unpacked_idx += delta; 2532 } 2533 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS; 2534 unusedLS = 0; 2535 src_bytes_left -= 1; 2536 src_idx += delta; 2537 } 2538 while (unpacked_bytes_left > 0) 2539 { 2540 accum |= sign << accumSize; 2541 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT); 2542 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2543 if (accumSize < 0) 2544 accumSize = 0; 2545 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2546 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1; 2547 unpacked_idx += delta; 2548 } 2549 } 2550 2551 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting 2552 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte, 2553 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then 2554 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from. 2555 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case, 2556 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the 2557 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval. 2558 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */ 2559 2560 struct value * 2561 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 2562 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size, 2563 struct type *type) 2564 { 2565 struct value *v; 2566 const gdb_byte *src; /* First byte containing data to unpack */ 2567 gdb_byte *unpacked; 2568 const int is_scalar = is_scalar_type (type); 2569 const int is_big_endian = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)); 2570 std::unique_ptr<gdb_byte[]> staging; 2571 int staging_len = 0; 2572 2573 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 2574 2575 if (obj == NULL) 2576 src = valaddr + offset; 2577 else 2578 src = value_contents (obj) + offset; 2579 2580 if (is_dynamic_type (type)) 2581 { 2582 /* The length of TYPE might by dynamic, so we need to resolve 2583 TYPE in order to know its actual size, which we then use 2584 to create the contents buffer of the value we return. 2585 The difficulty is that the data containing our object is 2586 packed, and therefore maybe not at a byte boundary. So, what 2587 we do, is unpack the data into a byte-aligned buffer, and then 2588 use that buffer as our object's value for resolving the type. */ 2589 staging_len = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2590 staging.reset (new gdb_byte[staging_len]); 2591 2592 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size, 2593 staging.get (), staging_len, 2594 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type), 2595 is_scalar); 2596 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, staging.get (), 0); 2597 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) < (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT) 2598 { 2599 /* This happens when the length of the object is dynamic, 2600 and is actually smaller than the space reserved for it. 2601 For instance, in an array of variant records, the bit_size 2602 we're given is the array stride, which is constant and 2603 normally equal to the maximum size of its element. 2604 But, in reality, each element only actually spans a portion 2605 of that stride. */ 2606 bit_size = TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2607 } 2608 } 2609 2610 if (obj == NULL) 2611 { 2612 v = allocate_value (type); 2613 src = valaddr + offset; 2614 } 2615 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj)) 2616 { 2617 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8; 2618 gdb_byte *buf; 2619 2620 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj) + offset); 2621 buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (src_len); 2622 read_memory (value_address (v), buf, src_len); 2623 src = buf; 2624 } 2625 else 2626 { 2627 v = allocate_value (type); 2628 src = value_contents (obj) + offset; 2629 } 2630 2631 if (obj != NULL) 2632 { 2633 long new_offset = offset; 2634 2635 set_value_component_location (v, obj); 2636 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj)); 2637 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size); 2638 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT) 2639 { 2640 ++new_offset; 2641 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT); 2642 } 2643 set_value_offset (v, new_offset); 2644 2645 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to 2646 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */ 2647 set_value_parent (v, obj); 2648 } 2649 else 2650 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size); 2651 unpacked = value_contents_writeable (v); 2652 2653 if (bit_size == 0) 2654 { 2655 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 2656 return v; 2657 } 2658 2659 if (staging != NULL && staging_len == TYPE_LENGTH (type)) 2660 { 2661 /* Small short-cut: If we've unpacked the data into a buffer 2662 of the same size as TYPE's length, then we can reuse that, 2663 instead of doing the unpacking again. */ 2664 memcpy (unpacked, staging.get (), staging_len); 2665 } 2666 else 2667 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size, 2668 unpacked, TYPE_LENGTH (type), 2669 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type), is_scalar); 2670 2671 return v; 2672 } 2673 2674 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to 2675 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must 2676 not overlap. */ 2677 static void 2678 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source, 2679 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p) 2680 { 2681 unsigned int accum, mask; 2682 int accum_bits, chunk_size; 2683 2684 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2685 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2686 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2687 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2688 if (bits_big_endian_p) 2689 { 2690 accum = (unsigned char) *source; 2691 source += 1; 2692 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset; 2693 2694 while (n > 0) 2695 { 2696 int unused_right; 2697 2698 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source; 2699 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2700 source += 1; 2701 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset; 2702 if (chunk_size > n) 2703 chunk_size = n; 2704 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset); 2705 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right; 2706 *target = 2707 (*target & ~mask) 2708 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask); 2709 n -= chunk_size; 2710 accum_bits -= chunk_size; 2711 target += 1; 2712 targ_offset = 0; 2713 } 2714 } 2715 else 2716 { 2717 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset; 2718 source += 1; 2719 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset; 2720 2721 while (n > 0) 2722 { 2723 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits); 2724 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2725 source += 1; 2726 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset; 2727 if (chunk_size > n) 2728 chunk_size = n; 2729 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset; 2730 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask); 2731 n -= chunk_size; 2732 accum_bits -= chunk_size; 2733 accum >>= chunk_size; 2734 target += 1; 2735 targ_offset = 0; 2736 } 2737 } 2738 } 2739 2740 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL. 2741 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of 2742 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have 2743 floating-point or non-scalar types. */ 2744 2745 static struct value * 2746 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval) 2747 { 2748 struct type *type = value_type (toval); 2749 int bits = value_bitsize (toval); 2750 2751 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval); 2752 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval); 2753 2754 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval))) 2755 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval); 2756 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval))) 2757 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval); 2758 2759 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval)) 2760 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue.")); 2761 2762 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory 2763 && bits > 0 2764 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT 2765 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)) 2766 { 2767 int len = (value_bitpos (toval) 2768 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 2769 int from_size; 2770 gdb_byte *buffer = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len); 2771 struct value *val; 2772 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval); 2773 2774 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT) 2775 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval); 2776 2777 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len); 2778 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval); 2779 if (from_size == 0) 2780 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 2781 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type))) 2782 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval), 2783 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1); 2784 else 2785 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval), 2786 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0); 2787 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len); 2788 2789 val = value_copy (toval); 2790 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval), 2791 TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 2792 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type); 2793 2794 return val; 2795 } 2796 2797 return value_assign (toval, fromval); 2798 } 2799 2800 2801 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue 2802 CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in 2803 CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not 2804 COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents 2805 of COMPONENT are ignored. 2806 2807 Although not part of the initial design, this function also works 2808 when CONTAINER and COMPONENT are not_lval's: it works as if CONTAINER 2809 had a null address, and COMPONENT had an address which is equal to 2810 its offset inside CONTAINER. */ 2811 2812 static void 2813 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component, 2814 struct value *val) 2815 { 2816 LONGEST offset_in_container = 2817 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container)); 2818 int bit_offset_in_container = 2819 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container); 2820 int bits; 2821 2822 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val); 2823 2824 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0) 2825 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)); 2826 else 2827 bits = value_bitsize (component); 2828 2829 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container)))) 2830 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container, 2831 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container, 2832 value_contents (val), 2833 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits, 2834 bits, 1); 2835 else 2836 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container, 2837 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container, 2838 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0); 2839 } 2840 2841 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND. 2842 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer 2843 thereto. */ 2844 2845 struct value * 2846 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind) 2847 { 2848 int k; 2849 struct value *elt; 2850 struct type *elt_type; 2851 2852 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr); 2853 2854 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt)); 2855 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 2856 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0) 2857 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind); 2858 2859 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1) 2860 { 2861 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 2862 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k); 2863 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k])); 2864 } 2865 return elt; 2866 } 2867 2868 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a GDB array, the value of the element 2869 of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND. 2870 Does not read the entire array into memory. 2871 2872 Note: Unlike what one would expect, this function is used instead of 2873 ada_value_subscript for basically all non-packed array types. The reason 2874 for this is that a side effect of doing our own pointer arithmetics instead 2875 of relying on value_subscript is that there is no implicit typedef peeling. 2876 This is important for arrays of array accesses, where it allows us to 2877 preserve the fact that the array's element is an array access, where the 2878 access part os encoded in a typedef layer. */ 2879 2880 static struct value * 2881 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind) 2882 { 2883 int k; 2884 struct value *array_ind = ada_value_ind (arr); 2885 struct type *type 2886 = check_typedef (value_enclosing_type (array_ind)); 2887 2888 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 2889 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0) 2890 return value_subscript_packed (array_ind, arity, ind); 2891 2892 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1) 2893 { 2894 LONGEST lwb, upb; 2895 struct value *lwb_value; 2896 2897 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 2898 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k); 2899 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)), 2900 value_copy (arr)); 2901 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb); 2902 lwb_value = value_from_longest (value_type(ind[k]), lwb); 2903 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - pos_atr (lwb_value)); 2904 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 2905 } 2906 2907 return value_ind (arr); 2908 } 2909 2910 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the 2911 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of 2912 HIGH'Pos-LOW'Pos+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of 2913 this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */ 2914 static struct value * 2915 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type, 2916 int low, int high) 2917 { 2918 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type); 2919 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)); 2920 struct type *index_type 2921 = create_static_range_type (NULL, base_index_type, low, high); 2922 struct type *slice_type = 2923 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type); 2924 int base_low = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)); 2925 LONGEST base_low_pos, low_pos; 2926 CORE_ADDR base; 2927 2928 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos) 2929 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, base_low, &base_low_pos)) 2930 { 2931 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead")); 2932 low_pos = low; 2933 base_low_pos = base_low; 2934 } 2935 2936 base = value_as_address (array_ptr) 2937 + ((low_pos - base_low_pos) 2938 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0))); 2939 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base); 2940 } 2941 2942 2943 static struct value * 2944 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high) 2945 { 2946 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)); 2947 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)); 2948 struct type *index_type 2949 = create_static_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high); 2950 struct type *slice_type = 2951 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type); 2952 LONGEST low_pos, high_pos; 2953 2954 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos) 2955 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, high, &high_pos)) 2956 { 2957 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead")); 2958 low_pos = low; 2959 high_pos = high; 2960 } 2961 2962 return value_cast (slice_type, 2963 value_slice (array, low, high_pos - low_pos + 1)); 2964 } 2965 2966 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array 2967 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a 2968 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its 2969 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */ 2970 2971 int 2972 ada_array_arity (struct type *type) 2973 { 2974 int arity; 2975 2976 if (type == NULL) 2977 return 0; 2978 2979 type = desc_base_type (type); 2980 2981 arity = 0; 2982 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 2983 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)); 2984 else 2985 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 2986 { 2987 arity += 1; 2988 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 2989 } 2990 2991 return arity; 2992 } 2993 2994 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array 2995 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for 2996 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if 2997 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */ 2998 2999 struct type * 3000 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices) 3001 { 3002 type = desc_base_type (type); 3003 3004 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 3005 { 3006 int k; 3007 struct type *p_array_type; 3008 3009 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type); 3010 3011 k = ada_array_arity (type); 3012 if (k == 0) 3013 return NULL; 3014 3015 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */ 3016 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices) 3017 k = nindices; 3018 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL) 3019 { 3020 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type)); 3021 k -= 1; 3022 } 3023 return p_array_type; 3024 } 3025 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 3026 { 3027 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 3028 { 3029 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 3030 nindices -= 1; 3031 } 3032 return type; 3033 } 3034 3035 return NULL; 3036 } 3037 3038 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1). 3039 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE 3040 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being 3041 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building 3042 the error message. */ 3043 3044 static struct type * 3045 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name) 3046 { 3047 struct type *result_type; 3048 3049 type = desc_base_type (type); 3050 3051 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type)) 3052 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name); 3053 3054 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)) 3055 { 3056 int i; 3057 3058 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1) 3059 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 3060 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)); 3061 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type 3062 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but 3063 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */ 3064 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF) 3065 result_type = NULL; 3066 } 3067 else 3068 { 3069 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n); 3070 if (result_type == NULL) 3071 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array")); 3072 } 3073 3074 return result_type; 3075 } 3076 3077 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the 3078 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if 3079 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an 3080 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied 3081 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */ 3082 3083 static LONGEST 3084 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which) 3085 { 3086 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type; 3087 int i; 3088 3089 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1); 3090 3091 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type)) 3092 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type); 3093 3094 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type)) 3095 return (LONGEST) - which; 3096 3097 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 3098 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type); 3099 else 3100 type = arr_type; 3101 3102 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type)) 3103 { 3104 /* The array has already been fixed, so we do not need to 3105 check the parallel ___XA type again. That encoding has 3106 already been applied, so ignore it now. */ 3107 index_type_desc = NULL; 3108 } 3109 else 3110 { 3111 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA"); 3112 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc); 3113 } 3114 3115 if (index_type_desc != NULL) 3116 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1), 3117 NULL); 3118 else 3119 { 3120 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type); 3121 3122 for (i = 1; i < n; i++) 3123 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type)); 3124 3125 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type); 3126 } 3127 3128 return 3129 (LONGEST) (which == 0 3130 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type) 3131 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type)); 3132 } 3133 3134 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the 3135 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if 3136 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds 3137 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */ 3138 3139 static LONGEST 3140 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which) 3141 { 3142 struct type *arr_type; 3143 3144 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 3145 arr = value_ind (arr); 3146 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr); 3147 3148 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type)) 3149 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which); 3150 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type)) 3151 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which); 3152 else 3153 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which)); 3154 } 3155 3156 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the 3157 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds 3158 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. 3159 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation 3160 clauses at the moment. */ 3161 3162 static LONGEST 3163 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n) 3164 { 3165 struct type *arr_type, *index_type; 3166 int low, high; 3167 3168 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 3169 arr = value_ind (arr); 3170 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr); 3171 3172 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type)) 3173 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n); 3174 3175 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type)) 3176 { 3177 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0); 3178 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1); 3179 } 3180 else 3181 { 3182 low = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)); 3183 high = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1)); 3184 } 3185 3186 arr_type = check_typedef (arr_type); 3187 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type); 3188 if (index_type != NULL) 3189 { 3190 struct type *base_type; 3191 if (TYPE_CODE (index_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) 3192 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (index_type); 3193 else 3194 base_type = index_type; 3195 3196 low = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, low)); 3197 high = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, high)); 3198 } 3199 return high - low + 1; 3200 } 3201 3202 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type), 3203 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */ 3204 3205 static struct value * 3206 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low) 3207 { 3208 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type); 3209 struct type *index_type 3210 = create_static_range_type 3211 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)), low, low - 1); 3212 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1); 3213 3214 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type)); 3215 } 3216 3217 3218 /* Name resolution */ 3219 3220 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding 3221 to OP. */ 3222 3223 static const char * 3224 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op) 3225 { 3226 int i; 3227 3228 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1) 3229 { 3230 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op) 3231 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded; 3232 } 3233 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode")); 3234 } 3235 3236 3237 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol 3238 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an 3239 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are 3240 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is 3241 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only 3242 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over 3243 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void 3244 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */ 3245 3246 static void 3247 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p) 3248 { 3249 struct type *context_type = NULL; 3250 int pc = 0; 3251 3252 if (void_context_p) 3253 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void; 3254 3255 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type); 3256 } 3257 3258 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at 3259 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing 3260 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes 3261 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with 3262 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and, 3263 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables 3264 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions 3265 are as in ada_resolve, above. */ 3266 3267 static struct value * 3268 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p, 3269 struct type *context_type) 3270 { 3271 int pc = *pos; 3272 int i; 3273 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */ 3274 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode; 3275 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */ 3276 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */ 3277 int oplen; 3278 3279 argvec = NULL; 3280 nargs = 0; 3281 exp = *expp; 3282 3283 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos, 3284 if needed. */ 3285 switch (op) 3286 { 3287 case OP_FUNCALL: 3288 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE 3289 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN) 3290 *pos += 7; 3291 else 3292 { 3293 *pos += 3; 3294 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL); 3295 } 3296 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 3297 break; 3298 3299 case UNOP_ADDR: 3300 *pos += 1; 3301 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL); 3302 break; 3303 3304 case UNOP_QUAL: 3305 *pos += 3; 3306 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type)); 3307 break; 3308 3309 case OP_ATR_MODULUS: 3310 case OP_ATR_SIZE: 3311 case OP_ATR_TAG: 3312 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 3313 case OP_ATR_LAST: 3314 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 3315 case OP_ATR_POS: 3316 case OP_ATR_VAL: 3317 case OP_ATR_MIN: 3318 case OP_ATR_MAX: 3319 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE: 3320 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS: 3321 case UNOP_IN_RANGE: 3322 case OP_AGGREGATE: 3323 case OP_OTHERS: 3324 case OP_CHOICES: 3325 case OP_POSITIONAL: 3326 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE: 3327 case OP_NAME: 3328 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs); 3329 *pos += oplen; 3330 break; 3331 3332 case BINOP_ASSIGN: 3333 { 3334 struct value *arg1; 3335 3336 *pos += 1; 3337 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL); 3338 if (arg1 == NULL) 3339 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL); 3340 else 3341 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1)); 3342 break; 3343 } 3344 3345 case UNOP_CAST: 3346 *pos += 3; 3347 nargs = 1; 3348 break; 3349 3350 case BINOP_ADD: 3351 case BINOP_SUB: 3352 case BINOP_MUL: 3353 case BINOP_DIV: 3354 case BINOP_REM: 3355 case BINOP_MOD: 3356 case BINOP_EXP: 3357 case BINOP_CONCAT: 3358 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND: 3359 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR: 3360 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND: 3361 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR: 3362 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR: 3363 3364 case BINOP_EQUAL: 3365 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL: 3366 case BINOP_LESS: 3367 case BINOP_GTR: 3368 case BINOP_LEQ: 3369 case BINOP_GEQ: 3370 3371 case BINOP_REPEAT: 3372 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT: 3373 case BINOP_COMMA: 3374 *pos += 1; 3375 nargs = 2; 3376 break; 3377 3378 case UNOP_NEG: 3379 case UNOP_PLUS: 3380 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT: 3381 case UNOP_ABS: 3382 case UNOP_IND: 3383 *pos += 1; 3384 nargs = 1; 3385 break; 3386 3387 case OP_LONG: 3388 case OP_DOUBLE: 3389 case OP_VAR_VALUE: 3390 *pos += 4; 3391 break; 3392 3393 case OP_TYPE: 3394 case OP_BOOL: 3395 case OP_LAST: 3396 case OP_INTERNALVAR: 3397 *pos += 3; 3398 break; 3399 3400 case UNOP_MEMVAL: 3401 *pos += 3; 3402 nargs = 1; 3403 break; 3404 3405 case OP_REGISTER: 3406 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1); 3407 break; 3408 3409 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT: 3410 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1); 3411 nargs = 1; 3412 break; 3413 3414 case TERNOP_SLICE: 3415 *pos += 1; 3416 nargs = 3; 3417 break; 3418 3419 case OP_STRING: 3420 break; 3421 3422 default: 3423 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution")); 3424 } 3425 3426 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 1); 3427 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1) 3428 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL); 3429 argvec[i] = NULL; 3430 exp = *expp; 3431 3432 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */ 3433 switch (op) 3434 { 3435 default: 3436 break; 3437 3438 case OP_VAR_VALUE: 3439 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN) 3440 { 3441 struct block_symbol *candidates; 3442 int n_candidates; 3443 3444 n_candidates = 3445 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME 3446 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), 3447 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN, 3448 &candidates); 3449 3450 if (n_candidates > 1) 3451 { 3452 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there 3453 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter 3454 out all types. */ 3455 int j; 3456 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1) 3457 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol)) 3458 { 3459 case LOC_REGISTER: 3460 case LOC_ARG: 3461 case LOC_REF_ARG: 3462 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR: 3463 case LOC_LOCAL: 3464 case LOC_COMPUTED: 3465 goto FoundNonType; 3466 default: 3467 break; 3468 } 3469 FoundNonType: 3470 if (j < n_candidates) 3471 { 3472 j = 0; 3473 while (j < n_candidates) 3474 { 3475 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol) == LOC_TYPEDEF) 3476 { 3477 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1]; 3478 n_candidates -= 1; 3479 } 3480 else 3481 j += 1; 3482 } 3483 } 3484 } 3485 3486 if (n_candidates == 0) 3487 error (_("No definition found for %s"), 3488 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)); 3489 else if (n_candidates == 1) 3490 i = 0; 3491 else if (deprocedure_p 3492 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates)) 3493 { 3494 i = ada_resolve_function 3495 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0, 3496 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), 3497 context_type); 3498 if (i < 0) 3499 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"), 3500 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)); 3501 } 3502 else 3503 { 3504 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), 3505 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)); 3506 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1); 3507 i = 0; 3508 } 3509 3510 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block; 3511 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].symbol; 3512 if (innermost_block == NULL 3513 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block)) 3514 innermost_block = candidates[i].block; 3515 } 3516 3517 if (deprocedure_p 3518 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)) 3519 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)) 3520 { 3521 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0, 3522 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol, 3523 exp->elts[pc + 1].block); 3524 exp = *expp; 3525 } 3526 break; 3527 3528 case OP_FUNCALL: 3529 { 3530 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE 3531 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN) 3532 { 3533 struct block_symbol *candidates; 3534 int n_candidates; 3535 3536 n_candidates = 3537 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME 3538 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol), 3539 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN, 3540 &candidates); 3541 if (n_candidates == 1) 3542 i = 0; 3543 else 3544 { 3545 i = ada_resolve_function 3546 (candidates, n_candidates, 3547 argvec, nargs, 3548 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol), 3549 context_type); 3550 if (i < 0) 3551 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"), 3552 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol)); 3553 } 3554 3555 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block; 3556 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].symbol; 3557 if (innermost_block == NULL 3558 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block)) 3559 innermost_block = candidates[i].block; 3560 } 3561 } 3562 break; 3563 case BINOP_ADD: 3564 case BINOP_SUB: 3565 case BINOP_MUL: 3566 case BINOP_DIV: 3567 case BINOP_REM: 3568 case BINOP_MOD: 3569 case BINOP_CONCAT: 3570 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND: 3571 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR: 3572 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR: 3573 case BINOP_EQUAL: 3574 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL: 3575 case BINOP_LESS: 3576 case BINOP_GTR: 3577 case BINOP_LEQ: 3578 case BINOP_GEQ: 3579 case BINOP_EXP: 3580 case UNOP_NEG: 3581 case UNOP_PLUS: 3582 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT: 3583 case UNOP_ABS: 3584 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec)) 3585 { 3586 struct block_symbol *candidates; 3587 int n_candidates; 3588 3589 n_candidates = 3590 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)), 3591 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN, 3592 &candidates); 3593 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs, 3594 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL); 3595 if (i < 0) 3596 break; 3597 3598 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1, 3599 candidates[i].symbol, 3600 candidates[i].block); 3601 exp = *expp; 3602 } 3603 break; 3604 3605 case OP_TYPE: 3606 case OP_REGISTER: 3607 return NULL; 3608 } 3609 3610 *pos = pc; 3611 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos); 3612 } 3613 3614 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If 3615 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual 3616 a non-pointer. */ 3617 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and 3618 liberal. */ 3619 3620 static int 3621 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref) 3622 { 3623 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype); 3624 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype); 3625 3626 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 3627 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype); 3628 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 3629 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype); 3630 3631 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype)) 3632 { 3633 default: 3634 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype); 3635 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: 3636 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 3637 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), 3638 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0); 3639 else 3640 return (may_deref 3641 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0)); 3642 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 3643 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 3644 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 3645 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype)) 3646 { 3647 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 3648 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 3649 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 3650 return 1; 3651 default: 3652 return 0; 3653 } 3654 3655 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY: 3656 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 3657 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype)); 3658 3659 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT: 3660 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype)) 3661 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 3662 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype)); 3663 else 3664 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 3665 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype)); 3666 3667 case TYPE_CODE_UNION: 3668 case TYPE_CODE_FLT: 3669 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype)); 3670 } 3671 } 3672 3673 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the 3674 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC 3675 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0- 3676 argument function. */ 3677 3678 static int 3679 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals) 3680 { 3681 int i; 3682 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func); 3683 3684 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST 3685 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 3686 return (n_actuals == 0); 3687 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC) 3688 return 0; 3689 3690 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals) 3691 return 0; 3692 3693 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1) 3694 { 3695 if (actuals[i] == NULL) 3696 return 0; 3697 else 3698 { 3699 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type, 3700 i)); 3701 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i])); 3702 3703 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1)) 3704 return 0; 3705 } 3706 } 3707 return 1; 3708 } 3709 3710 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value 3711 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if 3712 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type 3713 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */ 3714 3715 static int 3716 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type) 3717 { 3718 struct type *return_type; 3719 3720 if (func_type == NULL) 3721 return 1; 3722 3723 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC) 3724 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type)); 3725 else 3726 return_type = get_base_type (func_type); 3727 if (return_type == NULL) 3728 return 1; 3729 3730 context_type = get_base_type (context_type); 3731 3732 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 3733 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type; 3734 else if (context_type == NULL) 3735 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID; 3736 else 3737 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type); 3738 } 3739 3740 3741 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the 3742 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in 3743 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match 3744 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If 3745 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not 3746 return void, eliminate all matches that do. 3747 3748 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1 3749 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used 3750 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in 3751 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */ 3752 3753 static int 3754 ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol syms[], 3755 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs, 3756 const char *name, struct type *context_type) 3757 { 3758 int fallback; 3759 int k; 3760 int m; /* Number of hits */ 3761 3762 m = 0; 3763 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching 3764 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop 3765 where every function is accepted. */ 3766 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++) 3767 { 3768 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1) 3769 { 3770 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].symbol)); 3771 3772 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].symbol, args, nargs) 3773 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type))) 3774 { 3775 syms[m] = syms[k]; 3776 m += 1; 3777 } 3778 } 3779 } 3780 3781 /* If we got multiple matches, ask the user which one to use. Don't do this 3782 interactive thing during completion, though, as the purpose of the 3783 completion is providing a list of all possible matches. Prompting the 3784 user to filter it down would be completely unexpected in this case. */ 3785 if (m == 0) 3786 return -1; 3787 else if (m > 1 && !parse_completion) 3788 { 3789 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name); 3790 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1); 3791 return 0; 3792 } 3793 return 0; 3794 } 3795 3796 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1 3797 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below). 3798 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the 3799 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering 3800 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */ 3801 3802 static int 3803 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1) 3804 { 3805 if (N1 == NULL) 3806 return 0; 3807 else if (N0 == NULL) 3808 return 1; 3809 else 3810 { 3811 int k0, k1; 3812 3813 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1) 3814 ; 3815 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1) 3816 ; 3817 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000' 3818 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000') 3819 { 3820 int n0, n1; 3821 3822 n0 = k0; 3823 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_') 3824 n0 -= 1; 3825 n1 = k1; 3826 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_') 3827 n1 -= 1; 3828 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0) 3829 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1)); 3830 } 3831 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0); 3832 } 3833 } 3834 3835 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the 3836 encoded names. */ 3837 3838 static void 3839 sort_choices (struct block_symbol syms[], int nsyms) 3840 { 3841 int i; 3842 3843 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1) 3844 { 3845 struct block_symbol sym = syms[i]; 3846 int j; 3847 3848 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1) 3849 { 3850 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol), 3851 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.symbol))) 3852 break; 3853 syms[j + 1] = syms[j]; 3854 } 3855 syms[j + 1] = sym; 3856 } 3857 } 3858 3859 /* Whether GDB should display formals and return types for functions in the 3860 overloads selection menu. */ 3861 static int print_signatures = 1; 3862 3863 /* Print the signature for SYM on STREAM according to the FLAGS options. For 3864 all but functions, the signature is just the name of the symbol. For 3865 functions, this is the name of the function, the list of types for formals 3866 and the return type (if any). */ 3867 3868 static void 3869 ada_print_symbol_signature (struct ui_file *stream, struct symbol *sym, 3870 const struct type_print_options *flags) 3871 { 3872 struct type *type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym); 3873 3874 fprintf_filtered (stream, "%s", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym)); 3875 if (!print_signatures 3876 || type == NULL 3877 || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC) 3878 return; 3879 3880 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (type) > 0) 3881 { 3882 int i; 3883 3884 fprintf_filtered (stream, " ("); 3885 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); ++i) 3886 { 3887 if (i > 0) 3888 fprintf_filtered (stream, "; "); 3889 ada_print_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), NULL, stream, -1, 0, 3890 flags); 3891 } 3892 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")"); 3893 } 3894 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != NULL 3895 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) != TYPE_CODE_VOID) 3896 { 3897 fprintf_filtered (stream, " return "); 3898 ada_print_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, stream, -1, 0, flags); 3899 } 3900 } 3901 3902 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0 3903 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected, 3904 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols 3905 selected. */ 3906 3907 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought 3908 to be re-integrated one of these days. */ 3909 3910 int 3911 user_select_syms (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms, int max_results) 3912 { 3913 int i; 3914 int *chosen = XALLOCAVEC (int , nsyms); 3915 int n_chosen; 3916 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2; 3917 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode (); 3918 3919 if (max_results < 1) 3920 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!")); 3921 if (nsyms <= 1) 3922 return nsyms; 3923 3924 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel) 3925 error (_("\ 3926 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\ 3927 See set/show multiple-symbol.")); 3928 3929 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols. 3930 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course. 3931 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */ 3932 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1) 3933 return nsyms; 3934 3935 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n")); 3936 if (max_results > 1) 3937 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n")); 3938 3939 sort_choices (syms, nsyms); 3940 3941 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1) 3942 { 3943 if (syms[i].symbol == NULL) 3944 continue; 3945 3946 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_BLOCK) 3947 { 3948 struct symtab_and_line sal = 3949 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].symbol, 1); 3950 3951 printf_unfiltered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice); 3952 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol, 3953 &type_print_raw_options); 3954 if (sal.symtab == NULL) 3955 printf_unfiltered (_(" at <no source file available>:%d\n"), 3956 sal.line); 3957 else 3958 printf_unfiltered (_(" at %s:%d\n"), 3959 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab), 3960 sal.line); 3961 continue; 3962 } 3963 else 3964 { 3965 int is_enumeral = 3966 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_CONST 3967 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol) != NULL 3968 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM); 3969 struct symtab *symtab = NULL; 3970 3971 if (SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (syms[i].symbol)) 3972 symtab = symbol_symtab (syms[i].symbol); 3973 3974 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol) != 0 && symtab != NULL) 3975 { 3976 printf_unfiltered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice); 3977 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol, 3978 &type_print_raw_options); 3979 printf_unfiltered (_(" at %s:%d\n"), 3980 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab), 3981 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol)); 3982 } 3983 else if (is_enumeral 3984 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != NULL) 3985 { 3986 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice); 3987 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol), NULL, 3988 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options); 3989 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"), 3990 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].symbol)); 3991 } 3992 else 3993 { 3994 printf_unfiltered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice); 3995 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol, 3996 &type_print_raw_options); 3997 3998 if (symtab != NULL) 3999 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral 4000 ? _(" in %s (enumeral)\n") 4001 : _(" at %s:?\n"), 4002 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab)); 4003 else 4004 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral 4005 ? _(" (enumeral)\n") 4006 : _(" at ?\n")); 4007 } 4008 } 4009 } 4010 4011 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1, 4012 "overload-choice"); 4013 4014 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1) 4015 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]]; 4016 4017 return n_chosen; 4018 } 4019 4020 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the 4021 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing 4022 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N. 4023 4024 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line 4025 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows: 4026 4027 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error. 4028 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. 4029 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1. 4030 4031 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values. 4032 4033 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input 4034 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */ 4035 4036 int 4037 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results, 4038 int is_all_choice, const char *annotation_suffix) 4039 { 4040 char *args; 4041 const char *prompt; 4042 int n_chosen; 4043 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1; 4044 4045 prompt = getenv ("PS2"); 4046 if (prompt == NULL) 4047 prompt = "> "; 4048 4049 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix); 4050 4051 if (args == NULL) 4052 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers")); 4053 4054 n_chosen = 0; 4055 4056 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending 4057 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */ 4058 while (1) 4059 { 4060 char *args2; 4061 int choice, j; 4062 4063 args = skip_spaces (args); 4064 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0) 4065 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers")); 4066 else if (*args == '\0') 4067 break; 4068 4069 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10); 4070 if (args == args2 || choice < 0 4071 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1) 4072 error (_("Argument must be choice number")); 4073 args = args2; 4074 4075 if (choice == 0) 4076 error (_("cancelled")); 4077 4078 if (choice < first_choice) 4079 { 4080 n_chosen = n_choices; 4081 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1) 4082 choices[j] = j; 4083 break; 4084 } 4085 choice -= first_choice; 4086 4087 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1) 4088 { 4089 } 4090 4091 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j]) 4092 { 4093 int k; 4094 4095 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1) 4096 choices[k + 1] = choices[k]; 4097 choices[j + 1] = choice; 4098 n_chosen += 1; 4099 } 4100 } 4101 4102 if (n_chosen > max_results) 4103 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results); 4104 4105 return n_chosen; 4106 } 4107 4108 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call 4109 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS 4110 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */ 4111 4112 static void 4113 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs, 4114 int oplen, struct symbol *sym, 4115 const struct block *block) 4116 { 4117 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function 4118 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */ 4119 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *) 4120 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression) 4121 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen)); 4122 struct expression *exp = *expp; 4123 4124 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen; 4125 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn; 4126 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch; 4127 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc)); 4128 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen, 4129 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen)); 4130 4131 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL; 4132 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs; 4133 4134 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE; 4135 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block; 4136 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym; 4137 4138 *expp = newexp; 4139 xfree (exp); 4140 } 4141 4142 /* Type-class predicates */ 4143 4144 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type), 4145 or FLOAT). */ 4146 4147 static int 4148 numeric_type_p (struct type *type) 4149 { 4150 if (type == NULL) 4151 return 0; 4152 else 4153 { 4154 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 4155 { 4156 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 4157 case TYPE_CODE_FLT: 4158 return 1; 4159 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 4160 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) 4161 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))); 4162 default: 4163 return 0; 4164 } 4165 } 4166 } 4167 4168 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */ 4169 4170 static int 4171 integer_type_p (struct type *type) 4172 { 4173 if (type == NULL) 4174 return 0; 4175 else 4176 { 4177 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 4178 { 4179 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 4180 return 1; 4181 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 4182 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) 4183 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))); 4184 default: 4185 return 0; 4186 } 4187 } 4188 } 4189 4190 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */ 4191 4192 static int 4193 scalar_type_p (struct type *type) 4194 { 4195 if (type == NULL) 4196 return 0; 4197 else 4198 { 4199 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 4200 { 4201 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 4202 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 4203 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 4204 case TYPE_CODE_FLT: 4205 return 1; 4206 default: 4207 return 0; 4208 } 4209 } 4210 } 4211 4212 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */ 4213 4214 static int 4215 discrete_type_p (struct type *type) 4216 { 4217 if (type == NULL) 4218 return 0; 4219 else 4220 { 4221 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 4222 { 4223 case TYPE_CODE_INT: 4224 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 4225 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM: 4226 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL: 4227 return 1; 4228 default: 4229 return 0; 4230 } 4231 } 4232 } 4233 4234 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be 4235 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators 4236 (i.e., result 0). */ 4237 4238 static int 4239 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[]) 4240 { 4241 struct type *type0 = 4242 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0])); 4243 struct type *type1 = 4244 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1])); 4245 4246 if (type0 == NULL) 4247 return 0; 4248 4249 switch (op) 4250 { 4251 default: 4252 return 0; 4253 4254 case BINOP_ADD: 4255 case BINOP_SUB: 4256 case BINOP_MUL: 4257 case BINOP_DIV: 4258 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1))); 4259 4260 case BINOP_REM: 4261 case BINOP_MOD: 4262 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND: 4263 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR: 4264 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR: 4265 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1))); 4266 4267 case BINOP_EQUAL: 4268 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL: 4269 case BINOP_LESS: 4270 case BINOP_GTR: 4271 case BINOP_LEQ: 4272 case BINOP_GEQ: 4273 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1))); 4274 4275 case BINOP_CONCAT: 4276 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1); 4277 4278 case BINOP_EXP: 4279 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1))); 4280 4281 case UNOP_NEG: 4282 case UNOP_PLUS: 4283 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT: 4284 case UNOP_ABS: 4285 return (!numeric_type_p (type0)); 4286 4287 } 4288 } 4289 4290 /* Renaming */ 4291 4292 /* NOTES: 4293 4294 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may 4295 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some 4296 point. 4297 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of 4298 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point, 4299 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away 4300 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). 4301 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS 4302 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */ 4303 4304 /* If SYM encodes a renaming, 4305 4306 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>, 4307 4308 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name, 4309 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to 4310 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed 4311 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming 4312 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR 4313 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category 4314 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception 4315 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or 4316 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the 4317 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be 4318 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR 4319 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned. 4320 4321 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */ 4322 4323 enum ada_renaming_category 4324 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym, 4325 const char **renamed_entity, int *len, 4326 const char **renaming_expr) 4327 { 4328 enum ada_renaming_category kind; 4329 const char *info; 4330 const char *suffix; 4331 4332 if (sym == NULL) 4333 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4334 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym)) 4335 { 4336 default: 4337 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4338 case LOC_TYPEDEF: 4339 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym), 4340 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr); 4341 case LOC_LOCAL: 4342 case LOC_STATIC: 4343 case LOC_COMPUTED: 4344 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT: 4345 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR"); 4346 if (info == NULL) 4347 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4348 switch (info[5]) 4349 { 4350 case '_': 4351 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING; 4352 info += 6; 4353 break; 4354 case 'E': 4355 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING; 4356 info += 7; 4357 break; 4358 case 'P': 4359 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING; 4360 info += 7; 4361 break; 4362 case 'S': 4363 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING; 4364 info += 7; 4365 break; 4366 default: 4367 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4368 } 4369 } 4370 4371 if (renamed_entity != NULL) 4372 *renamed_entity = info; 4373 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE"); 4374 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info) 4375 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4376 if (len != NULL) 4377 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix); 4378 suffix += 5; 4379 if (renaming_expr != NULL) 4380 *renaming_expr = suffix; 4381 return kind; 4382 } 4383 4384 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in 4385 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY, 4386 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns 4387 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */ 4388 static enum ada_renaming_category 4389 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type, 4390 const char **renamed_entity, int *len, 4391 const char **renaming_expr) 4392 { 4393 enum ada_renaming_category kind; 4394 const char *name; 4395 const char *info; 4396 const char *suffix; 4397 4398 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM 4399 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1) 4400 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4401 4402 name = type_name_no_tag (type); 4403 if (name == NULL) 4404 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4405 4406 name = strstr (name, "___XR"); 4407 if (name == NULL) 4408 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4409 switch (name[5]) 4410 { 4411 case '\0': 4412 case '_': 4413 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING; 4414 break; 4415 case 'E': 4416 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING; 4417 break; 4418 case 'P': 4419 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING; 4420 break; 4421 case 'S': 4422 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING; 4423 break; 4424 default: 4425 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4426 } 4427 4428 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0); 4429 if (info == NULL) 4430 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4431 if (renamed_entity != NULL) 4432 *renamed_entity = info; 4433 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE"); 4434 if (renaming_expr != NULL) 4435 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5; 4436 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info) 4437 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING; 4438 if (len != NULL) 4439 *len = suffix - info; 4440 return kind; 4441 } 4442 4443 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to 4444 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block 4445 used to evaluate the renaming. */ 4446 4447 static struct value * 4448 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym, 4449 const struct block *block) 4450 { 4451 const char *sym_name; 4452 4453 sym_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (renaming_sym); 4454 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0); 4455 return evaluate_expression (expr.get ()); 4456 } 4457 4458 4459 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */ 4460 4461 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on 4462 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory 4463 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */ 4464 4465 static struct value * 4466 ensure_lval (struct value *val) 4467 { 4468 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval 4469 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar) 4470 { 4471 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val))); 4472 const CORE_ADDR addr = 4473 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len)); 4474 4475 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory; 4476 set_value_address (val, addr); 4477 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len); 4478 } 4479 4480 return val; 4481 } 4482 4483 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a 4484 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for 4485 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of 4486 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */ 4487 4488 struct value * 4489 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0) 4490 { 4491 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual)); 4492 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0); 4493 struct type *formal_target = 4494 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 4495 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type; 4496 struct type *actual_target = 4497 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 4498 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type; 4499 4500 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target) 4501 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 4502 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual); 4503 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 4504 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 4505 { 4506 struct value *result; 4507 4508 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 4509 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target)) 4510 result = desc_data (actual); 4511 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR) 4512 { 4513 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory) 4514 { 4515 struct value *val; 4516 4517 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual)); 4518 val = allocate_value (actual_type); 4519 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val), 4520 (char *) value_contents (actual), 4521 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type)); 4522 actual = ensure_lval (val); 4523 } 4524 result = value_addr (actual); 4525 } 4526 else 4527 return actual; 4528 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0); 4529 } 4530 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 4531 return ada_value_ind (actual); 4532 else if (ada_is_aligner_type (formal_type)) 4533 { 4534 /* We need to turn this parameter into an aligner type 4535 as well. */ 4536 struct value *aligner = allocate_value (formal_type); 4537 struct value *component = ada_value_struct_elt (aligner, "F", 0); 4538 4539 value_assign_to_component (aligner, component, actual); 4540 return aligner; 4541 } 4542 4543 return actual; 4544 } 4545 4546 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of 4547 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets 4548 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address 4549 differs. */ 4550 4551 static CORE_ADDR 4552 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type) 4553 { 4554 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type); 4555 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type); 4556 gdb_byte *buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len); 4557 CORE_ADDR addr; 4558 4559 addr = value_address (value); 4560 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr); 4561 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, gdbarch_byte_order (gdbarch)); 4562 return addr; 4563 } 4564 4565 4566 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at 4567 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either 4568 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer- 4569 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value * 4570 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */ 4571 4572 static struct value * 4573 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr) 4574 { 4575 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type); 4576 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type); 4577 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type); 4578 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type); 4579 int i; 4580 4581 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))); 4582 i > 0; i -= 1) 4583 { 4584 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds), 4585 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0), 4586 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0), 4587 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0)); 4588 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds), 4589 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1), 4590 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1), 4591 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1)); 4592 } 4593 4594 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds); 4595 4596 modify_field (value_type (descriptor), 4597 value_contents_writeable (descriptor), 4598 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr), 4599 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)), 4600 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type), 4601 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type)); 4602 4603 modify_field (value_type (descriptor), 4604 value_contents_writeable (descriptor), 4605 value_pointer (bounds, 4606 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)), 4607 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type), 4608 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type)); 4609 4610 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor); 4611 4612 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 4613 return value_addr (descriptor); 4614 else 4615 return descriptor; 4616 } 4617 4618 /* Symbol Cache Module */ 4619 4620 /* Performance measurements made as of 2010-01-15 indicate that 4621 this cache does bring some noticeable improvements. Depending 4622 on the type of entity being printed, the cache can make it as much 4623 as an order of magnitude faster than without it. 4624 4625 The descriptive type DWARF extension has significantly reduced 4626 the need for this cache, at least when DWARF is being used. However, 4627 even in this case, some expensive name-based symbol searches are still 4628 sometimes necessary - to find an XVZ variable, mostly. */ 4629 4630 /* Initialize the contents of SYM_CACHE. */ 4631 4632 static void 4633 ada_init_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache) 4634 { 4635 obstack_init (&sym_cache->cache_space); 4636 memset (sym_cache->root, '\000', sizeof (sym_cache->root)); 4637 } 4638 4639 /* Free the memory used by SYM_CACHE. */ 4640 4641 static void 4642 ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache) 4643 { 4644 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL); 4645 xfree (sym_cache); 4646 } 4647 4648 /* Return the symbol cache associated to the given program space PSPACE. 4649 If not allocated for this PSPACE yet, allocate and initialize one. */ 4650 4651 static struct ada_symbol_cache * 4652 ada_get_symbol_cache (struct program_space *pspace) 4653 { 4654 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = get_ada_pspace_data (pspace); 4655 4656 if (pspace_data->sym_cache == NULL) 4657 { 4658 pspace_data->sym_cache = XCNEW (struct ada_symbol_cache); 4659 ada_init_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache); 4660 } 4661 4662 return pspace_data->sym_cache; 4663 } 4664 4665 /* Clear all entries from the symbol cache. */ 4666 4667 static void 4668 ada_clear_symbol_cache (void) 4669 { 4670 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache 4671 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space); 4672 4673 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL); 4674 ada_init_symbol_cache (sym_cache); 4675 } 4676 4677 /* Search our cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN. 4678 Return it if found, or NULL otherwise. */ 4679 4680 static struct cache_entry ** 4681 find_entry (const char *name, domain_enum domain) 4682 { 4683 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache 4684 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space); 4685 int h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE; 4686 struct cache_entry **e; 4687 4688 for (e = &sym_cache->root[h]; *e != NULL; e = &(*e)->next) 4689 { 4690 if (domain == (*e)->domain && strcmp (name, (*e)->name) == 0) 4691 return e; 4692 } 4693 return NULL; 4694 } 4695 4696 /* Search the symbol cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN. 4697 Return 1 if found, 0 otherwise. 4698 4699 If an entry was found and SYM is not NULL, set *SYM to the entry's 4700 SYM. Same principle for BLOCK if not NULL. */ 4701 4702 static int 4703 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, 4704 struct symbol **sym, const struct block **block) 4705 { 4706 struct cache_entry **e = find_entry (name, domain); 4707 4708 if (e == NULL) 4709 return 0; 4710 if (sym != NULL) 4711 *sym = (*e)->sym; 4712 if (block != NULL) 4713 *block = (*e)->block; 4714 return 1; 4715 } 4716 4717 /* Assuming that (SYM, BLOCK) is the result of the lookup of NAME 4718 in domain DOMAIN, save this result in our symbol cache. */ 4719 4720 static void 4721 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, struct symbol *sym, 4722 const struct block *block) 4723 { 4724 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache 4725 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space); 4726 int h; 4727 char *copy; 4728 struct cache_entry *e; 4729 4730 /* Symbols for builtin types don't have a block. 4731 For now don't cache such symbols. */ 4732 if (sym != NULL && !SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (sym)) 4733 return; 4734 4735 /* If the symbol is a local symbol, then do not cache it, as a search 4736 for that symbol depends on the context. To determine whether 4737 the symbol is local or not, we check the block where we found it 4738 against the global and static blocks of its associated symtab. */ 4739 if (sym 4740 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)), 4741 GLOBAL_BLOCK) != block 4742 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)), 4743 STATIC_BLOCK) != block) 4744 return; 4745 4746 h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE; 4747 e = (struct cache_entry *) obstack_alloc (&sym_cache->cache_space, 4748 sizeof (*e)); 4749 e->next = sym_cache->root[h]; 4750 sym_cache->root[h] = e; 4751 e->name = copy 4752 = (char *) obstack_alloc (&sym_cache->cache_space, strlen (name) + 1); 4753 strcpy (copy, name); 4754 e->sym = sym; 4755 e->domain = domain; 4756 e->block = block; 4757 } 4758 4759 /* Symbol Lookup */ 4760 4761 /* Return nonzero if wild matching should be used when searching for 4762 all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME. 4763 4764 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation 4765 for Ada lookups (see ada_name_for_lookup). */ 4766 4767 static int 4768 should_use_wild_match (const char *lookup_name) 4769 { 4770 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL); 4771 } 4772 4773 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in 4774 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */ 4775 4776 static struct symbol * 4777 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block, 4778 domain_enum domain) 4779 { 4780 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */ 4781 struct block_symbol sym = {NULL, NULL}; 4782 4783 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym.symbol, NULL)) 4784 return sym.symbol; 4785 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0); 4786 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym.symbol, sym.block); 4787 return sym.symbol; 4788 } 4789 4790 4791 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol 4792 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions, 4793 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */ 4794 static int 4795 is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol syms[], int n) 4796 { 4797 int i; 4798 4799 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1) 4800 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC 4801 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM 4802 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) != LOC_CONST)) 4803 return 1; 4804 4805 return 0; 4806 } 4807 4808 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent 4809 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */ 4810 4811 static int 4812 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1) 4813 { 4814 if (type0 == type1) 4815 return 1; 4816 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL 4817 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1)) 4818 return 0; 4819 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 4820 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 4821 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL 4822 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0) 4823 return 1; 4824 4825 return 0; 4826 } 4827 4828 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is 4829 no more defined than that of SYM1. */ 4830 4831 static int 4832 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1) 4833 { 4834 if (sym0 == sym1) 4835 return 1; 4836 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1) 4837 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1)) 4838 return 0; 4839 4840 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0)) 4841 { 4842 case LOC_UNDEF: 4843 return 1; 4844 case LOC_TYPEDEF: 4845 { 4846 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0); 4847 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1); 4848 const char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0); 4849 const char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1); 4850 int len0 = strlen (name0); 4851 4852 return 4853 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1) 4854 && (equiv_types (type0, type1) 4855 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0 4856 && startswith (name1 + len0, "___XV"))); 4857 } 4858 case LOC_CONST: 4859 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1) 4860 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1)); 4861 default: 4862 return 0; 4863 } 4864 } 4865 4866 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct block_symbol 4867 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */ 4868 4869 static void 4870 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp, 4871 struct symbol *sym, 4872 const struct block *block) 4873 { 4874 int i; 4875 struct block_symbol *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0); 4876 4877 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably 4878 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the 4879 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub 4880 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan 4881 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client 4882 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several 4883 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter 4884 out the stub ones if needed. */ 4885 4886 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1) 4887 { 4888 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].symbol)) 4889 return; 4890 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].symbol, sym)) 4891 { 4892 prevDefns[i].symbol = sym; 4893 prevDefns[i].block = block; 4894 return; 4895 } 4896 } 4897 4898 { 4899 struct block_symbol info; 4900 4901 info.symbol = sym; 4902 info.block = block; 4903 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct block_symbol)); 4904 } 4905 } 4906 4907 /* Number of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in 4908 OBSTACKP. */ 4909 4910 static int 4911 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp) 4912 { 4913 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct block_symbol); 4914 } 4915 4916 /* Vector of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in 4917 OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return its final address. */ 4918 4919 static struct block_symbol * 4920 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish) 4921 { 4922 if (finish) 4923 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_finish (obstackp); 4924 else 4925 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_base (obstackp); 4926 } 4927 4928 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada 4929 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such 4930 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled 4931 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and 4932 global symbols are searched. */ 4933 4934 struct bound_minimal_symbol 4935 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name) 4936 { 4937 struct bound_minimal_symbol result; 4938 struct objfile *objfile; 4939 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol; 4940 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name); 4941 4942 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result)); 4943 4944 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package 4945 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without 4946 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order 4947 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions 4948 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error 4949 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error 4950 entity inside its program). */ 4951 if (startswith (name, "standard__")) 4952 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1; 4953 4954 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol) 4955 { 4956 if (match_name (MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match_p) 4957 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline) 4958 { 4959 result.minsym = msymbol; 4960 result.objfile = objfile; 4961 break; 4962 } 4963 } 4964 4965 return result; 4966 } 4967 4968 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the 4969 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN 4970 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for 4971 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME 4972 with a wildcard prefix. */ 4973 4974 static void 4975 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp, 4976 const char *name, domain_enum domain, 4977 int wild_match_p) 4978 { 4979 } 4980 4981 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol 4982 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */ 4983 4984 static int 4985 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type) 4986 { 4987 const char *name = ada_type_name (type); 4988 4989 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0); 4990 } 4991 4992 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types 4993 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. 4994 4995 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM 4996 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other 4997 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */ 4998 4999 static int 5000 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2) 5001 { 5002 int i; 5003 5004 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider 5005 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same 5006 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same 5007 underlying value and name. */ 5008 5009 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */ 5010 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++) 5011 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i)) 5012 return 0; 5013 5014 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical 5015 suffix). */ 5016 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++) 5017 { 5018 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i); 5019 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i); 5020 int len_1 = strlen (name_1); 5021 int len_2 = strlen (name_2); 5022 5023 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1); 5024 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2); 5025 if (len_1 != len_2 5026 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), 5027 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), 5028 len_1) != 0) 5029 return 0; 5030 } 5031 5032 return 1; 5033 } 5034 5035 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols 5036 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes, 5037 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar 5038 that they can be considered identical. 5039 5040 For instance, consider the following code: 5041 5042 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White); 5043 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue; 5044 5045 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy 5046 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is 5047 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color. 5048 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral 5049 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically 5050 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But 5051 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter 5052 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same. 5053 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */ 5054 5055 static int 5056 symbols_are_identical_enums (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms) 5057 { 5058 int i; 5059 5060 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type, 5061 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these 5062 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus 5063 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison. 5064 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks 5065 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */ 5066 5067 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */ 5068 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i++) 5069 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 5070 return 0; 5071 5072 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */ 5073 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++) 5074 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].symbol) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].symbol)) 5075 return 0; 5076 5077 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */ 5078 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++) 5079 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) 5080 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol))) 5081 return 0; 5082 5083 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of 5084 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete 5085 comparison of the type of each symbol. */ 5086 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++) 5087 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol), 5088 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol))) 5089 return 0; 5090 5091 return 1; 5092 } 5093 5094 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely 5095 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where 5096 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are 5097 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no 5098 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries. 5099 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */ 5100 5101 static int 5102 remove_extra_symbols (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms) 5103 { 5104 int i, j; 5105 5106 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there 5107 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to 5108 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */ 5109 if (nsyms < 2) 5110 return nsyms; 5111 5112 i = 0; 5113 while (i < nsyms) 5114 { 5115 int remove_p = 0; 5116 5117 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type, 5118 the get rid of the stub. */ 5119 5120 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) 5121 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].symbol) != NULL) 5122 { 5123 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++) 5124 { 5125 if (j != i 5126 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].symbol)) 5127 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol) != NULL 5128 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].symbol), 5129 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol)) == 0) 5130 remove_p = 1; 5131 } 5132 } 5133 5134 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address 5135 should be identical. */ 5136 5137 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].symbol) != NULL 5138 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_STATIC 5139 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol))) 5140 { 5141 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1) 5142 { 5143 if (i != j 5144 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol) != NULL 5145 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].symbol), 5146 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol)) == 0 5147 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) 5148 == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].symbol) 5149 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].symbol) 5150 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].symbol)) 5151 remove_p = 1; 5152 } 5153 } 5154 5155 if (remove_p) 5156 { 5157 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1) 5158 syms[j - 1] = syms[j]; 5159 nsyms -= 1; 5160 } 5161 5162 i += 1; 5163 } 5164 5165 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then 5166 just keep the first one and discard the rest. 5167 5168 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry 5169 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol 5170 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical 5171 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then 5172 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest. 5173 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have 5174 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to 5175 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list 5176 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */ 5177 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (syms, nsyms)) 5178 nsyms = 1; 5179 5180 return nsyms; 5181 } 5182 5183 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name 5184 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified, 5185 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been 5186 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */ 5187 5188 static char * 5189 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type) 5190 { 5191 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention: 5192 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>. 5193 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension, 5194 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */ 5195 5196 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type); 5197 const char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR"); 5198 const char *last; 5199 int scope_len; 5200 char *scope; 5201 5202 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking 5203 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */ 5204 5205 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--) 5206 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_') 5207 break; 5208 5209 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */ 5210 5211 scope_len = last - name; 5212 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char)); 5213 5214 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len); 5215 scope[scope_len] = '\0'; 5216 5217 return scope; 5218 } 5219 5220 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */ 5221 5222 static int 5223 is_package_name (const char *name) 5224 { 5225 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated 5226 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function. 5227 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent 5228 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one 5229 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */ 5230 5231 char *fun_name; 5232 5233 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level, 5234 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */ 5235 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL) 5236 return 0; 5237 5238 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function 5239 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */ 5240 5241 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level 5242 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */ 5243 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL) 5244 return 0; 5245 5246 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name); 5247 5248 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL); 5249 } 5250 5251 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is 5252 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */ 5253 5254 static int 5255 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name) 5256 { 5257 char *scope; 5258 struct cleanup *old_chain; 5259 5260 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF) 5261 return 0; 5262 5263 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym)); 5264 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, scope); 5265 5266 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */ 5267 if (is_package_name (scope)) 5268 { 5269 do_cleanups (old_chain); 5270 return 0; 5271 } 5272 5273 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking 5274 that its name starts with SCOPE. */ 5275 5276 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is 5277 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the 5278 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain 5279 this prefix. */ 5280 if (startswith (function_name, "_ada_")) 5281 function_name += 5; 5282 5283 { 5284 int is_invisible = !startswith (function_name, scope); 5285 5286 do_cleanups (old_chain); 5287 return is_invisible; 5288 } 5289 } 5290 5291 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that 5292 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or 5293 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming 5294 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of 5295 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols. 5296 5297 Rationale: 5298 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a 5299 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference 5300 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the 5301 latter. 5302 5303 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming 5304 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition 5305 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types 5306 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application 5307 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to 5308 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol 5309 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type. 5310 5311 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to 5312 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible 5313 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable 5314 method with the current information available. The implementation 5315 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12): 5316 5317 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there 5318 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the 5319 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the 5320 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is 5321 currently not the case. 5322 5323 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if 5324 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name 5325 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence, 5326 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */ 5327 5328 static int 5329 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct block_symbol *syms, 5330 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block) 5331 { 5332 struct symbol *current_function; 5333 const char *current_function_name; 5334 int i; 5335 int is_new_style_renaming; 5336 5337 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and 5338 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter. 5339 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */ 5340 is_new_style_renaming = 0; 5341 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1) 5342 { 5343 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].symbol; 5344 const struct block *block = syms[i].block; 5345 const char *name; 5346 const char *suffix; 5347 5348 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF) 5349 continue; 5350 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym); 5351 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR"); 5352 5353 if (suffix != NULL) 5354 { 5355 int name_len = suffix - name; 5356 int j; 5357 5358 is_new_style_renaming = 1; 5359 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1) 5360 if (i != j && syms[j].symbol != NULL 5361 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].symbol), 5362 name_len) == 0 5363 && block == syms[j].block) 5364 syms[j].symbol = NULL; 5365 } 5366 } 5367 if (is_new_style_renaming) 5368 { 5369 int j, k; 5370 5371 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1) 5372 if (syms[j].symbol != NULL) 5373 { 5374 syms[k] = syms[j]; 5375 k += 1; 5376 } 5377 return k; 5378 } 5379 5380 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK. 5381 Abort if unable to do so. */ 5382 5383 if (current_block == NULL) 5384 return nsyms; 5385 5386 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block); 5387 if (current_function == NULL) 5388 return nsyms; 5389 5390 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function); 5391 if (current_function_name == NULL) 5392 return nsyms; 5393 5394 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is 5395 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of 5396 the current block. */ 5397 5398 i = 0; 5399 while (i < nsyms) 5400 { 5401 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].symbol, NULL, NULL, NULL) 5402 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING 5403 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].symbol, current_function_name)) 5404 { 5405 int j; 5406 5407 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1) 5408 syms[j - 1] = syms[j]; 5409 nsyms -= 1; 5410 } 5411 else 5412 i += 1; 5413 } 5414 5415 return nsyms; 5416 } 5417 5418 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks) 5419 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively. 5420 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing" 5421 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function, 5422 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions). 5423 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in 5424 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info). 5425 5426 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */ 5427 5428 static void 5429 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name, 5430 const struct block *block, domain_enum domain, 5431 int wild_match_p) 5432 { 5433 int block_depth = 0; 5434 5435 while (block != NULL) 5436 { 5437 block_depth += 1; 5438 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, 5439 wild_match_p); 5440 5441 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */ 5442 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0), 5443 num_defns_collected (obstackp))) 5444 return; 5445 5446 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block); 5447 } 5448 5449 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically 5450 enclosing subprogram. */ 5451 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2) 5452 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match_p); 5453 } 5454 5455 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when 5456 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */ 5457 5458 struct match_data 5459 { 5460 struct objfile *objfile; 5461 struct obstack *obstackp; 5462 struct symbol *arg_sym; 5463 int found_sym; 5464 }; 5465 5466 /* A callback for add_nonlocal_symbols that adds SYM, found in BLOCK, 5467 to a list of symbols. DATA0 is a pointer to a struct match_data * 5468 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM 5469 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has 5470 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol 5471 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null, 5472 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no 5473 other has been found. */ 5474 5475 static int 5476 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block *block, struct symbol *sym, void *data0) 5477 { 5478 struct match_data *data = (struct match_data *) data0; 5479 5480 if (sym == NULL) 5481 { 5482 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL) 5483 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp, 5484 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile), 5485 block); 5486 data->found_sym = 0; 5487 data->arg_sym = NULL; 5488 } 5489 else 5490 { 5491 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED) 5492 return 0; 5493 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym)) 5494 data->arg_sym = sym; 5495 else 5496 { 5497 data->found_sym = 1; 5498 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp, 5499 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile), 5500 block); 5501 } 5502 } 5503 return 0; 5504 } 5505 5506 /* Helper for add_nonlocal_symbols. Find symbols in DOMAIN which are targetted 5507 by renamings matching NAME in BLOCK. Add these symbols to OBSTACKP. If 5508 WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in "wild" mode (see 5509 function "wild_match" for more information). Return whether we found such 5510 symbols. */ 5511 5512 static int 5513 ada_add_block_renamings (struct obstack *obstackp, 5514 const struct block *block, 5515 const char *name, 5516 domain_enum domain, 5517 int wild_match_p) 5518 { 5519 struct using_direct *renaming; 5520 int defns_mark = num_defns_collected (obstackp); 5521 5522 for (renaming = block_using (block); 5523 renaming != NULL; 5524 renaming = renaming->next) 5525 { 5526 const char *r_name; 5527 int name_match; 5528 5529 /* Avoid infinite recursions: skip this renaming if we are actually 5530 already traversing it. 5531 5532 Currently, symbol lookup in Ada don't use the namespace machinery from 5533 C++/Fortran support: skip namespace imports that use them. */ 5534 if (renaming->searched 5535 || (renaming->import_src != NULL 5536 && renaming->import_src[0] != '\0') 5537 || (renaming->import_dest != NULL 5538 && renaming->import_dest[0] != '\0')) 5539 continue; 5540 renaming->searched = 1; 5541 5542 /* TODO: here, we perform another name-based symbol lookup, which can 5543 pull its own multiple overloads. In theory, we should be able to do 5544 better in this case since, in DWARF, DW_AT_import is a DIE reference, 5545 not a simple name. But in order to do this, we would need to enhance 5546 the DWARF reader to associate a symbol to this renaming, instead of a 5547 name. So, for now, we do something simpler: re-use the C++/Fortran 5548 namespace machinery. */ 5549 r_name = (renaming->alias != NULL 5550 ? renaming->alias 5551 : renaming->declaration); 5552 name_match 5553 = wild_match_p ? wild_match (r_name, name) : strcmp (r_name, name); 5554 if (name_match == 0) 5555 ada_add_all_symbols (obstackp, block, renaming->declaration, domain, 5556 1, NULL); 5557 renaming->searched = 0; 5558 } 5559 return num_defns_collected (obstackp) != defns_mark; 5560 } 5561 5562 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using 5563 the given CASING. */ 5564 5565 static int 5566 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2, 5567 enum case_sensitivity casing) 5568 { 5569 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0') 5570 { 5571 char c1, c2; 5572 5573 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2)) 5574 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2); 5575 5576 if (casing == case_sensitive_off) 5577 { 5578 c1 = tolower (*string1); 5579 c2 = tolower (*string2); 5580 } 5581 else 5582 { 5583 c1 = *string1; 5584 c2 = *string2; 5585 } 5586 if (c1 != c2) 5587 break; 5588 5589 string1 += 1; 5590 string2 += 1; 5591 } 5592 5593 switch (*string1) 5594 { 5595 case '(': 5596 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2); 5597 case '_': 5598 if (*string2 == '\0') 5599 { 5600 if (is_name_suffix (string1)) 5601 return 0; 5602 else 5603 return 1; 5604 } 5605 /* FALLTHROUGH */ 5606 default: 5607 if (*string2 == '(') 5608 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2); 5609 else 5610 { 5611 if (casing == case_sensitive_off) 5612 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2); 5613 else 5614 return *string1 - *string2; 5615 } 5616 } 5617 } 5618 5619 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp. 5620 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that... 5621 5622 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0 5623 5624 ... implies... 5625 5626 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0 5627 5628 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */ 5629 5630 static int 5631 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2) 5632 { 5633 int result; 5634 5635 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform 5636 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to 5637 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was 5638 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */ 5639 5640 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off); 5641 if (result == 0) 5642 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on); 5643 5644 return result; 5645 } 5646 5647 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match 5648 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK 5649 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */ 5650 5651 static void 5652 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name, 5653 domain_enum domain, int global, 5654 int is_wild_match) 5655 { 5656 struct objfile *objfile; 5657 struct compunit_symtab *cu; 5658 struct match_data data; 5659 5660 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data); 5661 data.obstackp = obstackp; 5662 5663 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) 5664 { 5665 data.objfile = objfile; 5666 5667 if (is_wild_match) 5668 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global, 5669 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data, 5670 wild_match, NULL); 5671 else 5672 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global, 5673 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data, 5674 full_match, compare_names); 5675 5676 ALL_OBJFILE_COMPUNITS (objfile, cu) 5677 { 5678 const struct block *global_block 5679 = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (cu), GLOBAL_BLOCK); 5680 5681 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, global_block , name, domain, 5682 is_wild_match)) 5683 data.found_sym = 1; 5684 } 5685 } 5686 5687 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match) 5688 { 5689 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) 5690 { 5691 char *name1 = (char *) alloca (strlen (name) + sizeof ("_ada_")); 5692 strcpy (name1, "_ada_"); 5693 strcpy (name1 + sizeof ("_ada_") - 1, name); 5694 data.objfile = objfile; 5695 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1, domain, 5696 global, 5697 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, 5698 &data, 5699 full_match, compare_names); 5700 } 5701 } 5702 } 5703 5704 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK and, if FULL_SEARCH is 5705 non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of 5706 matches. Add these to OBSTACKP. 5707 5708 When FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral 5709 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK, 5710 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or 5711 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or 5712 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned. 5713 5714 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" 5715 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. 5716 5717 If MADE_GLOBAL_LOOKUP_P is non-null, set it before return to whether we had 5718 to lookup global symbols. */ 5719 5720 static void 5721 ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, 5722 const struct block *block, 5723 const char *name, 5724 domain_enum domain, 5725 int full_search, 5726 int *made_global_lookup_p) 5727 { 5728 struct symbol *sym; 5729 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name); 5730 5731 if (made_global_lookup_p) 5732 *made_global_lookup_p = 0; 5733 5734 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package 5735 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without 5736 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order 5737 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions 5738 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error 5739 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error 5740 entity inside its program). */ 5741 if (startswith (name, "standard__")) 5742 { 5743 block = NULL; 5744 name = name + sizeof ("standard__") - 1; 5745 } 5746 5747 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */ 5748 5749 if (block != NULL) 5750 { 5751 if (full_search) 5752 ada_add_local_symbols (obstackp, name, block, domain, wild_match_p); 5753 else 5754 { 5755 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by 5756 ada_iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search 5757 superblocks. */ 5758 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, 5759 wild_match_p); 5760 } 5761 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) > 0 || !full_search) 5762 return; 5763 } 5764 5765 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have 5766 already performed this search before. If we have, then return 5767 the same result. */ 5768 5769 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, &block)) 5770 { 5771 if (sym != NULL) 5772 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, sym, block); 5773 return; 5774 } 5775 5776 if (made_global_lookup_p) 5777 *made_global_lookup_p = 1; 5778 5779 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */ 5780 5781 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, name, domain, 1, wild_match_p); 5782 5783 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits 5784 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */ 5785 5786 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0) 5787 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, name, domain, 0, wild_match_p); 5788 } 5789 5790 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK and, if full_search is 5791 non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of 5792 matches. 5793 Sets *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples, 5794 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if 5795 any) in which they were found. This vector is transient---good only to 5796 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. 5797 5798 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral 5799 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK, 5800 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or 5801 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or 5802 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned. 5803 5804 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" 5805 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */ 5806 5807 static int 5808 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const char *name, const struct block *block, 5809 domain_enum domain, 5810 struct block_symbol **results, 5811 int full_search) 5812 { 5813 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name); 5814 int syms_from_global_search; 5815 int ndefns; 5816 5817 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL); 5818 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack); 5819 ada_add_all_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name, domain, 5820 full_search, &syms_from_global_search); 5821 5822 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack); 5823 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1); 5824 5825 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns); 5826 5827 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search && syms_from_global_search) 5828 cache_symbol (name, domain, NULL, NULL); 5829 5830 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && syms_from_global_search) 5831 cache_symbol (name, domain, (*results)[0].symbol, (*results)[0].block); 5832 5833 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block); 5834 return ndefns; 5835 } 5836 5837 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing scope and 5838 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and setting *RESULTS 5839 to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples. 5840 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */ 5841 5842 int 5843 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0, 5844 domain_enum domain, struct block_symbol **results) 5845 { 5846 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name0, block0, domain, results, 1); 5847 } 5848 5849 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */ 5850 5851 static void 5852 ada_iterate_over_symbols 5853 (const struct block *block, const char *name, domain_enum domain, 5854 gdb::function_view<symbol_found_callback_ftype> callback) 5855 { 5856 int ndefs, i; 5857 struct block_symbol *results; 5858 5859 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0); 5860 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i) 5861 { 5862 if (!callback (results[i].symbol)) 5863 break; 5864 } 5865 } 5866 5867 /* If NAME is the name of an entity, return a string that should 5868 be used to look that entity up in Ada units. 5869 5870 NAME can have any form that the "break" or "print" commands might 5871 recognize. In other words, it does not have to be the "natural" 5872 name, or the "encoded" name. */ 5873 5874 std::string 5875 ada_name_for_lookup (const char *name) 5876 { 5877 int nlen = strlen (name); 5878 5879 if (name[0] == '<' && name[nlen - 1] == '>') 5880 return std::string (name + 1, nlen - 2); 5881 else 5882 return ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)); 5883 } 5884 5885 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set 5886 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple 5887 choices. 5888 5889 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL. 5890 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */ 5891 5892 void 5893 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block, 5894 domain_enum domain, 5895 struct block_symbol *info) 5896 { 5897 struct block_symbol *candidates; 5898 int n_candidates; 5899 5900 gdb_assert (info != NULL); 5901 memset (info, 0, sizeof (struct block_symbol)); 5902 5903 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, domain, &candidates); 5904 if (n_candidates == 0) 5905 return; 5906 5907 *info = candidates[0]; 5908 info->symbol = fixup_symbol_section (info->symbol, NULL); 5909 } 5910 5911 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing 5912 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and 5913 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list, 5914 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices. 5915 If IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is not NULL, it is set to zero. */ 5916 5917 struct block_symbol 5918 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0, 5919 domain_enum domain, int *is_a_field_of_this) 5920 { 5921 struct block_symbol info; 5922 5923 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL) 5924 *is_a_field_of_this = 0; 5925 5926 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)), 5927 block0, domain, &info); 5928 return info; 5929 } 5930 5931 static struct block_symbol 5932 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const struct language_defn *langdef, 5933 const char *name, 5934 const struct block *block, 5935 const domain_enum domain) 5936 { 5937 struct block_symbol sym; 5938 5939 sym = ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain, NULL); 5940 if (sym.symbol != NULL) 5941 return sym; 5942 5943 /* If we haven't found a match at this point, try the primitive 5944 types. In other languages, this search is performed before 5945 searching for global symbols in order to short-circuit that 5946 global-symbol search if it happens that the name corresponds 5947 to a primitive type. But we cannot do the same in Ada, because 5948 it is perfectly legitimate for a program to declare a type which 5949 has the same name as a standard type. If looking up a type in 5950 that situation, we have traditionally ignored the primitive type 5951 in favor of user-defined types. This is why, unlike most other 5952 languages, we search the primitive types this late and only after 5953 having searched the global symbols without success. */ 5954 5955 if (domain == VAR_DOMAIN) 5956 { 5957 struct gdbarch *gdbarch; 5958 5959 if (block == NULL) 5960 gdbarch = target_gdbarch (); 5961 else 5962 gdbarch = block_gdbarch (block); 5963 sym.symbol = language_lookup_primitive_type_as_symbol (langdef, gdbarch, name); 5964 if (sym.symbol != NULL) 5965 return sym; 5966 } 5967 5968 return (struct block_symbol) {NULL, NULL}; 5969 } 5970 5971 5972 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name 5973 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel 5974 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes 5975 are given by any of the regular expressions: 5976 5977 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux] 5978 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX] 5979 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies] 5980 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes] 5981 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$ 5982 5983 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix 5984 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms, 5985 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */ 5986 5987 static int 5988 is_name_suffix (const char *str) 5989 { 5990 int k; 5991 const char *matching; 5992 const int len = strlen (str); 5993 5994 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */ 5995 5996 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2])) 5997 { 5998 str += 3; 5999 while (isdigit (str[0])) 6000 str += 1; 6001 } 6002 6003 /* [.$][0-9]+ */ 6004 6005 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$') 6006 { 6007 matching = str + 1; 6008 while (isdigit (matching[0])) 6009 matching += 1; 6010 if (matching[0] == '\0') 6011 return 1; 6012 } 6013 6014 /* ___[0-9]+ */ 6015 6016 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_') 6017 { 6018 matching = str + 3; 6019 while (isdigit (matching[0])) 6020 matching += 1; 6021 if (matching[0] == '\0') 6022 return 1; 6023 } 6024 6025 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */ 6026 6027 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0) 6028 return 1; 6029 6030 #if 0 6031 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end 6032 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same 6033 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating 6034 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes 6035 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated 6036 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose 6037 name ends with N. 6038 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some 6039 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding 6040 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do 6041 the following check. */ 6042 /* Protected Object Subprograms */ 6043 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N') 6044 return 1; 6045 #endif 6046 6047 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */ 6048 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2])) 6049 { 6050 matching = str + 3; 6051 while (isdigit (matching[0])) 6052 matching += 1; 6053 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's') 6054 && matching [1] == '\0') 6055 return 1; 6056 } 6057 6058 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This 6059 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find 6060 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching 6061 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we 6062 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */ 6063 if (str[0] == 'X') 6064 { 6065 str += 1; 6066 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0') 6067 { 6068 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b') 6069 return 0; 6070 str += 1; 6071 } 6072 } 6073 6074 if (str[0] == '\000') 6075 return 1; 6076 6077 if (str[0] == '_') 6078 { 6079 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000') 6080 return 0; 6081 if (str[2] == '_') 6082 { 6083 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0) 6084 return 1; 6085 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using 6086 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will 6087 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable 6088 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs 6089 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */ 6090 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0) 6091 return 1; 6092 if (str[3] != 'X') 6093 return 0; 6094 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B' 6095 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P') 6096 return 1; 6097 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T') 6098 return 1; 6099 return 0; 6100 } 6101 if (!isdigit (str[2])) 6102 return 0; 6103 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1) 6104 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_') 6105 return 0; 6106 return 1; 6107 } 6108 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1])) 6109 { 6110 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1) 6111 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_') 6112 return 0; 6113 return 1; 6114 } 6115 return 0; 6116 } 6117 6118 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before 6119 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */ 6120 6121 static int 6122 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0) 6123 { 6124 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0); 6125 int i; 6126 6127 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that 6128 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then 6129 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */ 6130 if (decoded_name[0] == '<') 6131 return 0; 6132 6133 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++) 6134 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i])) 6135 return 0; 6136 6137 return 1; 6138 } 6139 6140 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0 6141 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into 6142 the string beginning at NAME0. */ 6143 6144 static int 6145 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0) 6146 { 6147 const char *name = *namep; 6148 6149 while (1) 6150 { 6151 int t0, t1; 6152 6153 t0 = *name; 6154 if (t0 == '_') 6155 { 6156 t1 = name[1]; 6157 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9')) 6158 { 6159 name += 1; 6160 if (name == name0 + 5 && startswith (name0, "_ada")) 6161 break; 6162 else 6163 name += 1; 6164 } 6165 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z') 6166 || name[2] == target0)) 6167 { 6168 name += 2; 6169 break; 6170 } 6171 else 6172 return 0; 6173 } 6174 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9')) 6175 name += 1; 6176 else 6177 return 0; 6178 } 6179 6180 *namep = name; 6181 return 1; 6182 } 6183 6184 /* Return 0 iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN. Ignores any 6185 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is 6186 true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada simple name. */ 6187 6188 static int 6189 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn) 6190 { 6191 const char *p; 6192 const char *name0 = name; 6193 6194 while (1) 6195 { 6196 const char *match = name; 6197 6198 if (*name == *patn) 6199 { 6200 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1) 6201 if (*p != *name) 6202 break; 6203 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name)) 6204 return match != name0 && !is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0); 6205 6206 if (name[-1] == '_') 6207 name -= 1; 6208 } 6209 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn)) 6210 return 1; 6211 } 6212 } 6213 6214 /* Returns 0 iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, apart from 6215 informational suffix. */ 6216 6217 static int 6218 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name) 6219 { 6220 return !match_name (sym_name, search_name, 0); 6221 } 6222 6223 6224 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to 6225 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP 6226 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix. 6227 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */ 6228 6229 static void 6230 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, 6231 const struct block *block, const char *name, 6232 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile, 6233 int wild) 6234 { 6235 struct block_iterator iter; 6236 int name_len = strlen (name); 6237 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */ 6238 struct symbol *arg_sym; 6239 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */ 6240 int found_sym; 6241 struct symbol *sym; 6242 6243 arg_sym = NULL; 6244 found_sym = 0; 6245 if (wild) 6246 { 6247 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, wild_match, &iter); 6248 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, wild_match, &iter)) 6249 { 6250 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym), 6251 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain) 6252 && wild_match (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name) == 0) 6253 { 6254 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED) 6255 continue; 6256 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym)) 6257 arg_sym = sym; 6258 else 6259 { 6260 found_sym = 1; 6261 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, 6262 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile), 6263 block); 6264 } 6265 } 6266 } 6267 } 6268 else 6269 { 6270 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, full_match, &iter); 6271 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, full_match, &iter)) 6272 { 6273 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym), 6274 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)) 6275 { 6276 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED) 6277 { 6278 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym)) 6279 arg_sym = sym; 6280 else 6281 { 6282 found_sym = 1; 6283 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, 6284 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile), 6285 block); 6286 } 6287 } 6288 } 6289 } 6290 } 6291 6292 /* Handle renamings. */ 6293 6294 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, block, name, domain, wild)) 6295 found_sym = 1; 6296 6297 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL) 6298 { 6299 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, 6300 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile), 6301 block); 6302 } 6303 6304 if (!wild) 6305 { 6306 arg_sym = NULL; 6307 found_sym = 0; 6308 6309 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym) 6310 { 6311 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym), 6312 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)) 6313 { 6314 int cmp; 6315 6316 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0]; 6317 if (cmp == 0) 6318 { 6319 cmp = !startswith (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "_ada_"); 6320 if (cmp == 0) 6321 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5, 6322 name_len); 6323 } 6324 6325 if (cmp == 0 6326 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5)) 6327 { 6328 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED) 6329 { 6330 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym)) 6331 arg_sym = sym; 6332 else 6333 { 6334 found_sym = 1; 6335 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, 6336 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile), 6337 block); 6338 } 6339 } 6340 } 6341 } 6342 } 6343 6344 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols. 6345 They aren't parameters, right? */ 6346 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL) 6347 { 6348 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, 6349 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile), 6350 block); 6351 } 6352 } 6353 } 6354 6355 6356 /* Symbol Completion */ 6357 6358 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol 6359 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result 6360 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call. 6361 6362 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT. 6363 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH_P is set. 6364 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name 6365 in its encoded form. */ 6366 6367 static const char * 6368 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name, 6369 const char *text, int text_len, 6370 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p) 6371 { 6372 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<'); 6373 int match = 0; 6374 6375 if (verbatim_match) 6376 { 6377 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */ 6378 text = text + 1; 6379 text_len--; 6380 } 6381 6382 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */ 6383 6384 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0) 6385 match = 1; 6386 6387 if (match && !encoded_p) 6388 { 6389 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify 6390 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version 6391 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name 6392 is not a suitable completion. */ 6393 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name; 6394 int has_angle_bracket; 6395 6396 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name); 6397 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<'); 6398 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match); 6399 sym_name = sym_name_copy; 6400 } 6401 6402 if (match && !verbatim_match) 6403 { 6404 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to 6405 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name 6406 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would 6407 not be able to understand these symbol names without the 6408 angle bracket notation. */ 6409 const char *tmp; 6410 6411 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++); 6412 if (*tmp != '\0') 6413 match = 0; 6414 } 6415 6416 /* Second: Try wild matching... */ 6417 6418 if (!match && wild_match_p) 6419 { 6420 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT 6421 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must 6422 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */ 6423 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name)); 6424 6425 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0) 6426 match = 1; 6427 } 6428 6429 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */ 6430 6431 if (!match) 6432 return NULL; 6433 6434 if (verbatim_match) 6435 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name); 6436 6437 if (!encoded_p) 6438 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name); 6439 6440 return sym_name; 6441 } 6442 6443 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list(). 6444 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable 6445 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case 6446 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV. 6447 6448 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command 6449 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which 6450 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to 6451 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the 6452 completion vector. 6453 if WILD_MATCH_P is set, then wild matching is performed. 6454 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its 6455 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be 6456 encoded). */ 6457 6458 static void 6459 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv, 6460 const char *sym_name, 6461 const char *text, int text_len, 6462 const char *orig_text, const char *word, 6463 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p) 6464 { 6465 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len, 6466 wild_match_p, encoded_p); 6467 char *completion; 6468 6469 if (match == NULL) 6470 return; 6471 6472 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given 6473 string vector. */ 6474 6475 if (word == orig_text) 6476 { 6477 completion = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5); 6478 strcpy (completion, match); 6479 } 6480 else if (word > orig_text) 6481 { 6482 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */ 6483 completion = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5); 6484 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text)); 6485 } 6486 else 6487 { 6488 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */ 6489 completion = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5); 6490 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word); 6491 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0'; 6492 strcat (completion, match); 6493 } 6494 6495 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion); 6496 } 6497 6498 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. WORD is 6499 the entire command on which completion is made. */ 6500 6501 static VEC (char_ptr) * 6502 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (const char *text0, const char *word, 6503 enum type_code code) 6504 { 6505 char *text; 6506 int text_len; 6507 int wild_match_p; 6508 int encoded_p; 6509 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128); 6510 struct symbol *sym; 6511 struct compunit_symtab *s; 6512 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol; 6513 struct objfile *objfile; 6514 const struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0; 6515 int i; 6516 struct block_iterator iter; 6517 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); 6518 6519 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF); 6520 6521 if (text0[0] == '<') 6522 { 6523 text = xstrdup (text0); 6524 make_cleanup (xfree, text); 6525 text_len = strlen (text); 6526 wild_match_p = 0; 6527 encoded_p = 1; 6528 } 6529 else 6530 { 6531 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0)); 6532 make_cleanup (xfree, text); 6533 text_len = strlen (text); 6534 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++) 6535 text[i] = tolower (text[i]); 6536 6537 encoded_p = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL); 6538 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully 6539 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild 6540 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like 6541 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */ 6542 wild_match_p = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded_p); 6543 } 6544 6545 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */ 6546 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, 6547 [&] (const char *symname) 6548 { 6549 return symbol_completion_match (symname, 6550 text, text_len, 6551 wild_match_p, 6552 encoded_p); 6553 }, 6554 NULL, 6555 ALL_DOMAIN); 6556 6557 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each 6558 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore 6559 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be 6560 handled by the psymtab code above). */ 6561 6562 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol) 6563 { 6564 QUIT; 6565 symbol_completion_add (&completions, MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), 6566 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match_p, 6567 encoded_p); 6568 } 6569 6570 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can 6571 complete on local vars. */ 6572 6573 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b)) 6574 { 6575 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b)) 6576 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */ 6577 6578 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym) 6579 { 6580 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 6581 text, text_len, text0, word, 6582 wild_match_p, encoded_p); 6583 } 6584 } 6585 6586 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for 6587 symbols which match. */ 6588 6589 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s) 6590 { 6591 QUIT; 6592 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK); 6593 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym) 6594 { 6595 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 6596 text, text_len, text0, word, 6597 wild_match_p, encoded_p); 6598 } 6599 } 6600 6601 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s) 6602 { 6603 QUIT; 6604 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK); 6605 /* Don't do this block twice. */ 6606 if (b == surrounding_static_block) 6607 continue; 6608 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym) 6609 { 6610 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 6611 text, text_len, text0, word, 6612 wild_match_p, encoded_p); 6613 } 6614 } 6615 6616 do_cleanups (old_chain); 6617 return completions; 6618 } 6619 6620 /* Field Access */ 6621 6622 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used 6623 for tagged types. */ 6624 6625 static int 6626 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type) 6627 { 6628 const char *name; 6629 6630 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR) 6631 return 0; 6632 6633 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 6634 if (name == NULL) 6635 return 0; 6636 6637 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0); 6638 } 6639 6640 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */ 6641 6642 static int 6643 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type) 6644 { 6645 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (type); 6646 6647 if (name == NULL) 6648 return 0; 6649 6650 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0); 6651 } 6652 6653 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed 6654 to be invisible to users. */ 6655 6656 int 6657 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num) 6658 { 6659 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type)) 6660 return 1; 6661 6662 /* Check the name of that field. */ 6663 { 6664 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num); 6665 6666 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed. 6667 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen 6668 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */ 6669 if (name == NULL) 6670 return 1; 6671 6672 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_") 6673 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler, 6674 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special, 6675 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler 6676 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from 6677 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but 6678 should not be ignored either. */ 6679 if (name[0] == '_' && !startswith (name, "_parent")) 6680 return 1; 6681 } 6682 6683 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag, 6684 then ignore. */ 6685 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1) 6686 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)) 6687 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))) 6688 return 1; 6689 6690 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */ 6691 return 0; 6692 } 6693 6694 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a 6695 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */ 6696 6697 int 6698 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok) 6699 { 6700 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL); 6701 } 6702 6703 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */ 6704 6705 int 6706 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type) 6707 { 6708 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 6709 6710 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR) 6711 return 0; 6712 else 6713 { 6714 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 6715 6716 return (name != NULL 6717 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0); 6718 } 6719 } 6720 6721 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */ 6722 6723 struct type * 6724 ada_tag_type (struct value *val) 6725 { 6726 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL); 6727 } 6728 6729 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95, 6730 retired at Ada 05). */ 6731 6732 static int 6733 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag) 6734 { 6735 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL; 6736 } 6737 6738 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */ 6739 6740 struct value * 6741 ada_value_tag (struct value *val) 6742 { 6743 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0); 6744 } 6745 6746 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are 6747 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address 6748 ADDRESS. */ 6749 6750 static struct value * 6751 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type, 6752 const gdb_byte *valaddr, 6753 CORE_ADDR address) 6754 { 6755 int tag_byte_offset; 6756 struct type *tag_type; 6757 6758 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset, 6759 NULL, NULL, NULL)) 6760 { 6761 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL) 6762 ? NULL 6763 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset); 6764 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset; 6765 6766 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1); 6767 } 6768 return NULL; 6769 } 6770 6771 static struct type * 6772 type_from_tag (struct value *tag) 6773 { 6774 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag); 6775 6776 if (type_name != NULL) 6777 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name)); 6778 return NULL; 6779 } 6780 6781 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this 6782 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as 6783 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of 6784 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full 6785 view can be fetched. */ 6786 6787 struct value * 6788 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj) 6789 { 6790 struct value *val; 6791 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0; 6792 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type; 6793 struct value *tag; 6794 CORE_ADDR base_address; 6795 6796 obj_type = value_type (obj); 6797 6798 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */ 6799 6800 if (TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 6801 || TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 6802 return obj; 6803 6804 tag = ada_value_tag (obj); 6805 if (!tag) 6806 return obj; 6807 6808 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */ 6809 6810 if (is_ada95_tag (tag)) 6811 return obj; 6812 6813 ptr_type = builtin_type (target_gdbarch ())->builtin_data_ptr; 6814 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type); 6815 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag); 6816 if (!val) 6817 return obj; 6818 6819 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while 6820 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag; 6821 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error 6822 message for the same reason. */ 6823 6824 TRY 6825 { 6826 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2))); 6827 } 6828 6829 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) 6830 { 6831 return obj; 6832 } 6833 END_CATCH 6834 6835 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */ 6836 6837 if (offset_to_top == 0) 6838 return obj; 6839 6840 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done 6841 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for 6842 now. */ 6843 6844 if (offset_to_top == -1) 6845 return obj; 6846 6847 base_address = value_address (obj) - offset_to_top; 6848 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address); 6849 6850 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address. 6851 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when 6852 the object is not initialized yet). */ 6853 6854 if (!tag) 6855 return obj; 6856 6857 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag); 6858 6859 if (!obj_type) 6860 return obj; 6861 6862 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address); 6863 } 6864 6865 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */ 6866 6867 static struct type * 6868 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf) 6869 { 6870 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf); 6871 6872 if (data->tsd_type == 0) 6873 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data"); 6874 return data->tsd_type; 6875 } 6876 6877 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG. 6878 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity. 6879 6880 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */ 6881 6882 static struct value * 6883 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag) 6884 { 6885 struct value *val; 6886 struct type *type; 6887 6888 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG. 6889 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have 6890 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for 6891 the current approach except the absence of that field. */ 6892 6893 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1); 6894 if (val) 6895 return val; 6896 6897 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which 6898 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, 6899 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch 6900 table. */ 6901 6902 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior()); 6903 if (type == NULL) 6904 return NULL; 6905 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type)); 6906 val = value_cast (type, tag); 6907 if (val == NULL) 6908 return NULL; 6909 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1)); 6910 } 6911 6912 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string 6913 containing the name of the associated type. 6914 6915 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL 6916 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */ 6917 6918 static char * 6919 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd) 6920 { 6921 static char name[1024]; 6922 char *p; 6923 struct value *val; 6924 6925 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1); 6926 if (val == NULL) 6927 return NULL; 6928 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1); 6929 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1) 6930 if (isalpha (*p)) 6931 *p = tolower (*p); 6932 return name; 6933 } 6934 6935 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as 6936 a C string. 6937 6938 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to 6939 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next 6940 call. */ 6941 6942 const char * 6943 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag) 6944 { 6945 char *name = NULL; 6946 6947 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag))) 6948 return NULL; 6949 6950 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying 6951 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances: 6952 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for 6953 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point. 6954 instead we return NULL. 6955 6956 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very 6957 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let 6958 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */ 6959 TRY 6960 { 6961 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag); 6962 6963 if (tsd != NULL) 6964 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd); 6965 } 6966 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) 6967 { 6968 } 6969 END_CATCH 6970 6971 return name; 6972 } 6973 6974 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */ 6975 6976 struct type * 6977 ada_parent_type (struct type *type) 6978 { 6979 int i; 6980 6981 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 6982 6983 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 6984 return NULL; 6985 6986 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1) 6987 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i)) 6988 { 6989 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i); 6990 6991 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */ 6992 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 6993 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type); 6994 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */ 6995 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type); 6996 6997 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type); 6998 } 6999 7000 return NULL; 7001 } 7002 7003 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the 7004 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is 7005 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */ 7006 7007 int 7008 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num) 7009 { 7010 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num); 7011 7012 return (name != NULL 7013 && (startswith (name, "PARENT") 7014 || startswith (name, "_parent"))); 7015 } 7016 7017 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a 7018 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing 7019 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a 7020 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always 7021 structures. */ 7022 7023 int 7024 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num) 7025 { 7026 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num); 7027 7028 if (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "RETVAL") == 0) 7029 { 7030 /* This happens in functions with "out" or "in out" parameters 7031 which are passed by copy. For such functions, GNAT describes 7032 the function's return type as being a struct where the return 7033 value is in a field called RETVAL, and where the other "out" 7034 or "in out" parameters are fields of that struct. This is not 7035 a wrapper. */ 7036 return 0; 7037 } 7038 7039 return (name != NULL 7040 && (startswith (name, "PARENT") 7041 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0 7042 || startswith (name, "_parent") 7043 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O')); 7044 } 7045 7046 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE 7047 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least 7048 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */ 7049 7050 int 7051 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num) 7052 { 7053 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num); 7054 7055 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION 7056 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num) 7057 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type)) 7058 == TYPE_CODE_UNION))); 7059 } 7060 7061 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part) 7062 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE, 7063 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant. 7064 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */ 7065 7066 struct type * 7067 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type) 7068 { 7069 const char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type); 7070 7071 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL); 7072 } 7073 7074 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a 7075 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE 7076 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */ 7077 7078 int 7079 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num) 7080 { 7081 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num); 7082 7083 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O'); 7084 } 7085 7086 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record, 7087 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant. 7088 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */ 7089 7090 const char * 7091 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0) 7092 { 7093 static char *result = NULL; 7094 static size_t result_len = 0; 7095 struct type *type; 7096 const char *name; 7097 const char *discrim_end; 7098 const char *discrim_start; 7099 7100 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 7101 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0); 7102 else 7103 type = type0; 7104 7105 name = ada_type_name (type); 7106 7107 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000') 7108 return ""; 7109 7110 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name; 7111 discrim_end -= 1) 7112 { 7113 if (startswith (discrim_end, "___XVN")) 7114 break; 7115 } 7116 if (discrim_end == name) 7117 return ""; 7118 7119 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3; 7120 discrim_start -= 1) 7121 { 7122 if (discrim_start == name + 1) 7123 return ""; 7124 if ((discrim_start > name + 3 7125 && startswith (discrim_start - 3, "___")) 7126 || discrim_start[-1] == '.') 7127 break; 7128 } 7129 7130 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1); 7131 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start); 7132 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0'; 7133 return result; 7134 } 7135 7136 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K. 7137 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in 7138 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL. 7139 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0 7140 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value 7141 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number. 7142 Assumes 0m does not occur. */ 7143 7144 int 7145 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k) 7146 { 7147 ULONGEST RU; 7148 7149 if (!isdigit (str[k])) 7150 return 0; 7151 7152 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about 7153 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and 7154 LONGEST. */ 7155 RU = 0; 7156 while (isdigit (str[k])) 7157 { 7158 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0'); 7159 k += 1; 7160 } 7161 7162 if (str[k] == 'm') 7163 { 7164 if (R != NULL) 7165 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1; 7166 k += 1; 7167 } 7168 else if (R != NULL) 7169 *R = (LONGEST) RU; 7170 7171 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of 7172 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive 7173 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work 7174 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch 7175 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */ 7176 7177 if (new_k != NULL) 7178 *new_k = k; 7179 return 1; 7180 } 7181 7182 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field), 7183 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is 7184 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */ 7185 7186 int 7187 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num) 7188 { 7189 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num); 7190 int p; 7191 7192 p = 0; 7193 while (1) 7194 { 7195 switch (name[p]) 7196 { 7197 case '\0': 7198 return 0; 7199 case 'S': 7200 { 7201 LONGEST W; 7202 7203 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p)) 7204 return 0; 7205 if (val == W) 7206 return 1; 7207 break; 7208 } 7209 case 'R': 7210 { 7211 LONGEST L, U; 7212 7213 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p) 7214 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p)) 7215 return 0; 7216 if (val >= L && val <= U) 7217 return 1; 7218 break; 7219 } 7220 case 'O': 7221 return 1; 7222 default: 7223 return 0; 7224 } 7225 } 7226 } 7227 7228 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */ 7229 7230 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type 7231 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static) 7232 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field 7233 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */ 7234 7235 static struct value * 7236 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno, 7237 struct type *arg_type) 7238 { 7239 struct type *type; 7240 7241 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type); 7242 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno); 7243 7244 /* Handle packed fields. */ 7245 7246 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0) 7247 { 7248 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno); 7249 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno); 7250 7251 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1), 7252 offset + bit_pos / 8, 7253 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type); 7254 } 7255 else 7256 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type); 7257 } 7258 7259 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found, 7260 set the following for each argument that is non-null: 7261 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type; 7262 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within 7263 an object of that type; 7264 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field; 7265 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and 7266 0 otherwise; 7267 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible 7268 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total 7269 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never 7270 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case. 7271 7272 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */ 7273 7274 static int 7275 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset, 7276 struct type **field_type_p, 7277 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p, 7278 int *index_p) 7279 { 7280 int i; 7281 7282 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 7283 7284 if (field_type_p != NULL) 7285 *field_type_p = NULL; 7286 if (byte_offset_p != NULL) 7287 *byte_offset_p = 0; 7288 if (bit_offset_p != NULL) 7289 *bit_offset_p = 0; 7290 if (bit_size_p != NULL) 7291 *bit_size_p = 0; 7292 7293 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1) 7294 { 7295 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i); 7296 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8; 7297 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i); 7298 7299 if (t_field_name == NULL) 7300 continue; 7301 7302 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name)) 7303 { 7304 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i); 7305 7306 if (field_type_p != NULL) 7307 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i); 7308 if (byte_offset_p != NULL) 7309 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset; 7310 if (bit_offset_p != NULL) 7311 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8; 7312 if (bit_size_p != NULL) 7313 *bit_size_p = bit_size; 7314 return 1; 7315 } 7316 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i)) 7317 { 7318 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset, 7319 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p, 7320 bit_size_p, index_p)) 7321 return 1; 7322 } 7323 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i)) 7324 { 7325 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of 7326 fixed type?? */ 7327 int j; 7328 struct type *field_type 7329 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i)); 7330 7331 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1) 7332 { 7333 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j), 7334 fld_offset 7335 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8, 7336 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, 7337 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p)) 7338 return 1; 7339 } 7340 } 7341 else if (index_p != NULL) 7342 *index_p += 1; 7343 } 7344 return 0; 7345 } 7346 7347 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */ 7348 7349 static int 7350 num_visible_fields (struct type *type) 7351 { 7352 int n; 7353 7354 n = 0; 7355 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n); 7356 return n; 7357 } 7358 7359 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes, 7360 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE. 7361 If found, return value, else return NULL. 7362 7363 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */ 7364 7365 static struct value * 7366 ada_search_struct_field (const char *name, struct value *arg, int offset, 7367 struct type *type) 7368 { 7369 int i; 7370 7371 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 7372 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1) 7373 { 7374 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i); 7375 7376 if (t_field_name == NULL) 7377 continue; 7378 7379 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name)) 7380 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type); 7381 7382 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i)) 7383 { 7384 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */ 7385 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 7386 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8, 7387 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i)); 7388 7389 if (v != NULL) 7390 return v; 7391 } 7392 7393 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i)) 7394 { 7395 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */ 7396 int j; 7397 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 7398 i)); 7399 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8; 7400 7401 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1) 7402 { 7403 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line 7404 break. */ 7405 (name, arg, 7406 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8, 7407 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j)); 7408 7409 if (v != NULL) 7410 return v; 7411 } 7412 } 7413 } 7414 return NULL; 7415 } 7416 7417 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *, 7418 int, struct type *); 7419 7420 7421 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by 7422 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address 7423 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE. 7424 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */ 7425 7426 static struct value * 7427 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset, 7428 struct type *type) 7429 { 7430 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type); 7431 } 7432 7433 7434 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like 7435 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies 7436 * *INDEX_P. */ 7437 7438 static struct value * 7439 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset, 7440 struct type *type) 7441 { 7442 int i; 7443 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 7444 7445 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1) 7446 { 7447 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL) 7448 continue; 7449 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i)) 7450 { 7451 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */ 7452 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg, 7453 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8, 7454 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i)); 7455 7456 if (v != NULL) 7457 return v; 7458 } 7459 7460 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i)) 7461 { 7462 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field, 7463 find_struct_field. */ 7464 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record")); 7465 } 7466 else if (*index_p == 0) 7467 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type); 7468 else 7469 *index_p -= 1; 7470 } 7471 return NULL; 7472 } 7473 7474 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)* 7475 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate 7476 target structure/union and return it as a value with its 7477 appropriate type. 7478 7479 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself 7480 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members 7481 (e.g., '_parent'). 7482 7483 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than 7484 calling error. */ 7485 7486 struct value * 7487 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, const char *name, int no_err) 7488 { 7489 struct type *t, *t1; 7490 struct value *v; 7491 7492 v = NULL; 7493 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg)); 7494 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 7495 { 7496 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t); 7497 if (t1 == NULL) 7498 goto BadValue; 7499 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1); 7500 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 7501 { 7502 arg = coerce_ref (arg); 7503 t = t1; 7504 } 7505 } 7506 7507 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 7508 { 7509 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t); 7510 if (t1 == NULL) 7511 goto BadValue; 7512 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1); 7513 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 7514 { 7515 arg = value_ind (arg); 7516 t = t1; 7517 } 7518 else 7519 break; 7520 } 7521 7522 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION) 7523 goto BadValue; 7524 7525 if (t1 == t) 7526 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t); 7527 else 7528 { 7529 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset; 7530 struct type *field_type; 7531 CORE_ADDR address; 7532 7533 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 7534 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg)); 7535 else 7536 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg)); 7537 7538 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1); 7539 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0, 7540 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset, 7541 &bit_size, NULL)) 7542 { 7543 if (bit_size != 0) 7544 { 7545 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 7546 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg); 7547 else 7548 arg = ada_value_ind (arg); 7549 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset, 7550 bit_offset, bit_size, 7551 field_type); 7552 } 7553 else 7554 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset); 7555 } 7556 } 7557 7558 if (v != NULL || no_err) 7559 return v; 7560 else 7561 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name); 7562 7563 BadValue: 7564 if (no_err) 7565 return NULL; 7566 else 7567 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of " 7568 "a value that is not a record.")); 7569 } 7570 7571 /* Return a string representation of type TYPE. */ 7572 7573 static std::string 7574 type_as_string (struct type *type) 7575 { 7576 string_file tmp_stream; 7577 7578 type_print (type, "", &tmp_stream, -1); 7579 7580 return std::move (tmp_stream.string ()); 7581 } 7582 7583 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME. 7584 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a 7585 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not 7586 work for packed fields). 7587 7588 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly 7589 followed by "___". 7590 7591 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also 7592 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the 7593 ultimate target type will be searched. 7594 7595 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types. 7596 7597 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or 7598 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */ 7599 7600 static struct type * 7601 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, const char *name, int refok, 7602 int noerr, int *dispp) 7603 { 7604 int i; 7605 7606 if (name == NULL) 7607 goto BadName; 7608 7609 if (refok && type != NULL) 7610 while (1) 7611 { 7612 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 7613 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR 7614 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF) 7615 break; 7616 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 7617 } 7618 7619 if (type == NULL 7620 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 7621 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)) 7622 { 7623 if (noerr) 7624 return NULL; 7625 7626 error (_("Type %s is not a structure or union type"), 7627 type != NULL ? type_as_string (type).c_str () : _("(null)")); 7628 } 7629 7630 type = to_static_fixed_type (type); 7631 7632 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1) 7633 { 7634 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i); 7635 struct type *t; 7636 int disp; 7637 7638 if (t_field_name == NULL) 7639 continue; 7640 7641 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name)) 7642 { 7643 if (dispp != NULL) 7644 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8; 7645 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i); 7646 } 7647 7648 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i)) 7649 { 7650 disp = 0; 7651 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name, 7652 0, 1, &disp); 7653 if (t != NULL) 7654 { 7655 if (dispp != NULL) 7656 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8; 7657 return t; 7658 } 7659 } 7660 7661 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i)) 7662 { 7663 int j; 7664 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 7665 i)); 7666 7667 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1) 7668 { 7669 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is 7670 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes 7671 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit 7672 if the compiler changes this practice. */ 7673 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j); 7674 disp = 0; 7675 if (v_field_name != NULL 7676 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name)) 7677 t = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j); 7678 else 7679 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, 7680 j), 7681 name, 0, 1, &disp); 7682 7683 if (t != NULL) 7684 { 7685 if (dispp != NULL) 7686 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8; 7687 return t; 7688 } 7689 } 7690 } 7691 7692 } 7693 7694 BadName: 7695 if (!noerr) 7696 { 7697 const char *name_str = name != NULL ? name : _("<null>"); 7698 7699 error (_("Type %s has no component named %s"), 7700 type_as_string (type).c_str (), name_str); 7701 } 7702 7703 return NULL; 7704 } 7705 7706 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union), 7707 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE 7708 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a 7709 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */ 7710 7711 static int 7712 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type) 7713 { 7714 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type); 7715 7716 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL) 7717 == NULL); 7718 } 7719 7720 7721 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union), 7722 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at 7723 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE, 7724 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */ 7725 7726 int 7727 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type, 7728 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr) 7729 { 7730 int others_clause; 7731 int i; 7732 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type); 7733 struct value *outer; 7734 struct value *discrim; 7735 LONGEST discrim_val; 7736 7737 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes problems 7738 because we will end up trying to resolve a type that is currently 7739 being constructed. */ 7740 outer = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (outer_type, 7741 outer_valaddr, 0); 7742 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1); 7743 if (discrim == NULL) 7744 return -1; 7745 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim); 7746 7747 others_clause = -1; 7748 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1) 7749 { 7750 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i)) 7751 others_clause = i; 7752 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i)) 7753 return i; 7754 } 7755 7756 return others_clause; 7757 } 7758 7759 7760 7761 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */ 7762 7763 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size 7764 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging 7765 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value. 7766 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate, 7767 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */ 7768 7769 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot 7770 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However, 7771 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent 7772 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size 7773 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space 7774 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the 7775 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters, 7776 rather than struct value*s. 7777 7778 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are 7779 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in 7780 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in 7781 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all 7782 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described 7783 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the 7784 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values. 7785 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal 7786 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained 7787 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each 7788 element selected. */ 7789 7790 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host 7791 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value. 7792 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal 7793 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the 7794 target at the target address. */ 7795 7796 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of 7797 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of 7798 dynamic-sized types. */ 7799 7800 struct value * 7801 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0) 7802 { 7803 struct value *val = value_ind (val0); 7804 7805 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0)) 7806 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val); 7807 7808 return ada_to_fixed_value (val); 7809 } 7810 7811 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to" 7812 qualifiers on VAL0. */ 7813 7814 static struct value * 7815 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0) 7816 { 7817 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 7818 { 7819 struct value *val = val0; 7820 7821 val = coerce_ref (val); 7822 7823 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0)) 7824 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val); 7825 7826 return ada_to_fixed_value (val); 7827 } 7828 else 7829 return val0; 7830 } 7831 7832 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of 7833 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */ 7834 7835 static unsigned int 7836 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment) 7837 { 7838 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1); 7839 } 7840 7841 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */ 7842 7843 static unsigned int 7844 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f) 7845 { 7846 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f); 7847 int len; 7848 int align_offset; 7849 7850 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information 7851 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not 7852 require any alignment. */ 7853 if (name == NULL) 7854 return 1; 7855 7856 len = strlen (name); 7857 7858 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1])) 7859 return 1; 7860 7861 if (isdigit (name[len - 2])) 7862 align_offset = len - 2; 7863 else 7864 align_offset = len - 1; 7865 7866 if (align_offset < 7 || !startswith (name + align_offset - 6, "___XV")) 7867 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 7868 7869 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 7870 } 7871 7872 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */ 7873 7874 static struct symbol * 7875 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name) 7876 { 7877 struct symbol *sym; 7878 7879 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN); 7880 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF) 7881 return sym; 7882 7883 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN); 7884 return sym; 7885 } 7886 7887 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look 7888 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB 7889 primitive types. */ 7890 7891 static struct type * 7892 ada_find_any_type (const char *name) 7893 { 7894 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name); 7895 7896 if (sym != NULL) 7897 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym); 7898 7899 return NULL; 7900 } 7901 7902 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol 7903 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming 7904 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for 7905 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR". 7906 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */ 7907 7908 struct symbol * 7909 ada_find_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym, const struct block *block) 7910 { 7911 const char *name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (name_sym); 7912 struct symbol *sym; 7913 7914 if (strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL) 7915 return name_sym; 7916 7917 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block); 7918 7919 if (sym != NULL) 7920 return sym; 7921 7922 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */ 7923 sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name); 7924 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL) 7925 return sym; 7926 else 7927 return NULL; 7928 } 7929 7930 static struct symbol * 7931 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block) 7932 { 7933 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block); 7934 char *rename; 7935 7936 if (function_sym != NULL) 7937 { 7938 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully 7939 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name 7940 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of 7941 the associated renaming symbol. */ 7942 const char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym); 7943 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used 7944 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building 7945 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is 7946 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function 7947 name length below. */ 7948 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name); 7949 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */ 7950 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ; 7951 7952 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */ 7953 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len); 7954 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len); 7955 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len); 7956 7957 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds 7958 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace 7959 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not 7960 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */ 7961 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */ 7962 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name) 7963 { 7964 function_name += 5; 7965 function_name_len -= 5; 7966 } 7967 7968 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char)); 7969 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len); 7970 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len, 7971 "__%s___XR", name); 7972 } 7973 else 7974 { 7975 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6; 7976 7977 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char)); 7978 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name); 7979 } 7980 7981 return ada_find_any_type_symbol (rename); 7982 } 7983 7984 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a 7985 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to 7986 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero; 7987 otherwise return 0. */ 7988 7989 int 7990 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1) 7991 { 7992 if (type1 == NULL) 7993 return 1; 7994 else if (type0 == NULL) 7995 return 0; 7996 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID) 7997 return 1; 7998 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID) 7999 return 0; 8000 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL) 8001 return 1; 8002 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0)) 8003 return 1; 8004 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0) 8005 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1)) 8006 return 1; 8007 else 8008 { 8009 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0); 8010 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1); 8011 8012 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL 8013 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL)) 8014 return 1; 8015 } 8016 return 0; 8017 } 8018 8019 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is 8020 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */ 8021 8022 const char * 8023 ada_type_name (struct type *type) 8024 { 8025 if (type == NULL) 8026 return NULL; 8027 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL) 8028 return TYPE_NAME (type); 8029 else 8030 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type); 8031 } 8032 8033 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type 8034 whose name is NAME. */ 8035 8036 static struct type * 8037 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name) 8038 { 8039 struct type *result, *tmp; 8040 8041 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p) 8042 return NULL; 8043 8044 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type 8045 to be found. */ 8046 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type)) 8047 return NULL; 8048 8049 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type); 8050 while (result != NULL) 8051 { 8052 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result); 8053 8054 if (result_name == NULL) 8055 { 8056 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type")); 8057 return NULL; 8058 } 8059 8060 /* If the names match, stop. */ 8061 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0) 8062 break; 8063 8064 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */ 8065 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result)) 8066 tmp = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result); 8067 else 8068 tmp = NULL; 8069 8070 /* If not found either, try after having resolved the typedef. */ 8071 if (tmp != NULL) 8072 result = tmp; 8073 else 8074 { 8075 result = check_typedef (result); 8076 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result)) 8077 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result); 8078 else 8079 result = NULL; 8080 } 8081 } 8082 8083 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With 8084 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or 8085 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails. 8086 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */ 8087 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)) 8088 return ada_find_any_type (name); 8089 8090 return result; 8091 } 8092 8093 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the 8094 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available, 8095 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */ 8096 8097 static struct type * 8098 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name) 8099 { 8100 struct type *result = NULL; 8101 8102 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type)) 8103 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name); 8104 else 8105 result = ada_find_any_type (name); 8106 8107 return result; 8108 } 8109 8110 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending 8111 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */ 8112 8113 struct type * 8114 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix) 8115 { 8116 char *name; 8117 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type); 8118 int len; 8119 8120 if (type_name == NULL) 8121 return NULL; 8122 8123 len = strlen (type_name); 8124 8125 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1); 8126 8127 strcpy (name, type_name); 8128 strcpy (name + len, suffix); 8129 8130 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name); 8131 } 8132 8133 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template 8134 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */ 8135 8136 static struct type * 8137 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type) 8138 { 8139 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 8140 8141 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 8142 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL) 8143 return NULL; 8144 else 8145 { 8146 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type)); 8147 8148 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0) 8149 return type; 8150 else 8151 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE"); 8152 } 8153 } 8154 8155 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns 8156 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */ 8157 8158 static int 8159 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num) 8160 { 8161 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num); 8162 8163 return name != NULL 8164 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 8165 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL; 8166 } 8167 8168 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not 8169 represent a variant record type. */ 8170 8171 static int 8172 variant_field_index (struct type *type) 8173 { 8174 int f; 8175 8176 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 8177 return -1; 8178 8179 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1) 8180 { 8181 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f)) 8182 return f; 8183 } 8184 return -1; 8185 } 8186 8187 /* A record type with no fields. */ 8188 8189 static struct type * 8190 empty_record (struct type *templ) 8191 { 8192 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (templ); 8193 8194 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT; 8195 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0; 8196 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL; 8197 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type); 8198 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>"; 8199 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL; 8200 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0; 8201 return type; 8202 } 8203 8204 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes 8205 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at 8206 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions. 8207 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any 8208 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is 8209 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A 8210 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch 8211 of the variant. 8212 8213 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or 8214 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence, 8215 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored. 8216 8217 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and 8218 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be 8219 byte-aligned. */ 8220 8221 struct type * 8222 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type, 8223 const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8224 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0, 8225 int keep_dynamic_fields) 8226 { 8227 struct value *mark = value_mark (); 8228 struct value *dval; 8229 struct type *rtype; 8230 int nfields, bit_len; 8231 int variant_field; 8232 long off; 8233 int fld_bit_len; 8234 int f; 8235 8236 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going 8237 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only 8238 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */ 8239 if (keep_dynamic_fields) 8240 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type); 8241 else 8242 { 8243 nfields = 0; 8244 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type) 8245 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields) 8246 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields)) 8247 nfields++; 8248 } 8249 8250 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type); 8251 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT; 8252 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype); 8253 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields; 8254 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *) 8255 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field)); 8256 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields); 8257 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type); 8258 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL; 8259 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1; 8260 8261 off = 0; 8262 bit_len = 0; 8263 variant_field = -1; 8264 8265 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1) 8266 { 8267 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f)) 8268 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f); 8269 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off); 8270 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0; 8271 8272 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f)) 8273 { 8274 variant_field = f; 8275 fld_bit_len = 0; 8276 } 8277 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f)) 8278 { 8279 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr; 8280 CORE_ADDR field_address = address; 8281 struct type *field_type = 8282 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f)); 8283 8284 if (dval0 == NULL) 8285 { 8286 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time 8287 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not 8288 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and 8289 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the 8290 size first before creating the value. */ 8291 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (rtype); 8292 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here 8293 causes problems because we will end up trying to 8294 resolve a type that is currently being 8295 constructed. */ 8296 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, 8297 valaddr, 8298 address); 8299 rtype = value_type (dval); 8300 } 8301 else 8302 dval = dval0; 8303 8304 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need 8305 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set. 8306 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong 8307 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields 8308 that follow this one. */ 8309 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type)) 8310 { 8311 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f); 8312 8313 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset); 8314 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset); 8315 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type); 8316 } 8317 8318 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, 8319 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT); 8320 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, 8321 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT); 8322 8323 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case, 8324 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if 8325 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record, 8326 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real 8327 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We 8328 would end up in an infinite loop. */ 8329 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type); 8330 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr, 8331 field_address, dval, 0); 8332 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum 8333 object size, then the record itself will necessarily 8334 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make 8335 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously 8336 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior) 8337 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the 8338 record size. */ 8339 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (field_type); 8340 8341 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type; 8342 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f); 8343 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because 8344 the field length has been size-checked just above, and 8345 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value, 8346 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than 8347 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code, 8348 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */ 8349 fld_bit_len = 8350 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 8351 } 8352 else 8353 { 8354 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important 8355 to preserve the typedef layer. 8356 8357 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat 8358 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array), 8359 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained 8360 array). As both types are implemented using the same 8361 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us 8362 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it 8363 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */ 8364 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f); 8365 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f); 8366 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0) 8367 fld_bit_len = 8368 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f); 8369 else 8370 { 8371 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f); 8372 8373 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing 8374 the length of our field. If this is a typedef, 8375 get the length of the target type, not the length 8376 of the typedef. */ 8377 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 8378 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type); 8379 8380 fld_bit_len = 8381 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 8382 } 8383 } 8384 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len) 8385 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len; 8386 off += fld_bit_len; 8387 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = 8388 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 8389 } 8390 8391 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain 8392 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of 8393 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation 8394 clauses. */ 8395 if (variant_field >= 0) 8396 { 8397 struct type *branch_type; 8398 8399 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field); 8400 8401 if (dval0 == NULL) 8402 { 8403 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes 8404 problems because we will end up trying to resolve a type 8405 that is currently being constructed. */ 8406 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, valaddr, 8407 address); 8408 rtype = value_type (dval); 8409 } 8410 else 8411 dval = dval0; 8412 8413 branch_type = 8414 to_fixed_variant_branch_type 8415 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field), 8416 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), 8417 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval); 8418 if (branch_type == NULL) 8419 { 8420 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1) 8421 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f]; 8422 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1; 8423 } 8424 else 8425 { 8426 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type; 8427 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S"; 8428 fld_bit_len = 8429 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) * 8430 TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 8431 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len) 8432 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len; 8433 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = 8434 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT; 8435 } 8436 } 8437 8438 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records 8439 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly 8440 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most 8441 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size 8442 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure, 8443 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */ 8444 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0) 8445 { 8446 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype)) 8447 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."), 8448 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 8449 else 8450 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."), 8451 TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 8452 } 8453 else 8454 { 8455 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype), 8456 TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 8457 } 8458 8459 value_free_to_mark (mark); 8460 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit) 8461 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit")); 8462 return rtype; 8463 } 8464 8465 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS 8466 of 1. */ 8467 8468 static struct type * 8469 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8470 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0) 8471 { 8472 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr, 8473 address, dval0, 1); 8474 } 8475 8476 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and 8477 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with 8478 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses 8479 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK, 8480 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both 8481 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize 8482 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the 8483 template type. */ 8484 8485 static struct type * 8486 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0) 8487 { 8488 struct type *type; 8489 int nfields; 8490 int f; 8491 8492 /* No need no do anything if the input type is already fixed. */ 8493 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0)) 8494 return type0; 8495 8496 /* Likewise if we already have computed the static approximation. */ 8497 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL) 8498 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0); 8499 8500 /* Don't clone TYPE0 until we are sure we are going to need a copy. */ 8501 type = type0; 8502 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0); 8503 8504 /* Whether or not we cloned TYPE0, cache the result so that we don't do 8505 recompute all over next time. */ 8506 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type; 8507 8508 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1) 8509 { 8510 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f); 8511 struct type *new_type; 8512 8513 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f)) 8514 { 8515 field_type = ada_check_typedef (field_type); 8516 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type)); 8517 } 8518 else 8519 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type); 8520 8521 if (new_type != field_type) 8522 { 8523 /* Clone TYPE0 only the first time we get a new field type. */ 8524 if (type == type0) 8525 { 8526 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0); 8527 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0); 8528 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type); 8529 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields; 8530 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *) 8531 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field)); 8532 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0), 8533 sizeof (struct field) * nfields); 8534 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0); 8535 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL; 8536 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1; 8537 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0; 8538 } 8539 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type; 8540 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f); 8541 } 8542 } 8543 8544 return type; 8545 } 8546 8547 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and 8548 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE, 8549 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant 8550 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks 8551 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record 8552 contains the necessary discriminant values. */ 8553 8554 static struct type * 8555 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8556 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0) 8557 { 8558 struct value *mark = value_mark (); 8559 struct value *dval; 8560 struct type *rtype; 8561 struct type *branch_type; 8562 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type); 8563 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type); 8564 8565 if (variant_field == -1) 8566 return type; 8567 8568 if (dval0 == NULL) 8569 { 8570 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address); 8571 type = value_type (dval); 8572 } 8573 else 8574 dval = dval0; 8575 8576 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type); 8577 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT; 8578 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype); 8579 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields; 8580 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = 8581 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field)); 8582 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type), 8583 sizeof (struct field) * nfields); 8584 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type); 8585 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL; 8586 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1; 8587 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type); 8588 8589 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type 8590 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field), 8591 cond_offset_host (valaddr, 8592 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field) 8593 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), 8594 cond_offset_target (address, 8595 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field) 8596 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval); 8597 if (branch_type == NULL) 8598 { 8599 int f; 8600 8601 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1) 8602 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f]; 8603 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1; 8604 } 8605 else 8606 { 8607 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type; 8608 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S"; 8609 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0; 8610 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type); 8611 } 8612 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field)); 8613 8614 value_free_to_mark (mark); 8615 return rtype; 8616 } 8617 8618 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes 8619 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at 8620 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values 8621 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object 8622 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values. 8623 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant 8624 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL, 8625 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless 8626 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant. 8627 8628 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0 8629 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the 8630 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the 8631 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in 8632 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention 8633 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this 8634 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */ 8635 8636 static struct type * 8637 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8638 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval) 8639 { 8640 struct type *templ_type; 8641 8642 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0)) 8643 return type0; 8644 8645 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0); 8646 8647 if (templ_type != NULL) 8648 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval); 8649 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0) 8650 { 8651 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0) 8652 return type0; 8653 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address, 8654 dval); 8655 } 8656 else 8657 { 8658 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1; 8659 return type0; 8660 } 8661 8662 } 8663 8664 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes 8665 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a 8666 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL, 8667 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate 8668 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value 8669 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if 8670 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */ 8671 8672 static struct type * 8673 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8674 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval) 8675 { 8676 int which; 8677 struct type *templ_type; 8678 struct type *var_type; 8679 8680 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 8681 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0); 8682 else 8683 var_type = var_type0; 8684 8685 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU"); 8686 8687 if (templ_type != NULL) 8688 var_type = templ_type; 8689 8690 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval))) 8691 return var_type0; 8692 which = 8693 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type, 8694 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval)); 8695 8696 if (which < 0) 8697 return empty_record (var_type); 8698 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which)) 8699 return to_fixed_record_type 8700 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)), 8701 valaddr, address, dval); 8702 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0) 8703 return 8704 to_fixed_record_type 8705 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval); 8706 else 8707 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which); 8708 } 8709 8710 /* Assuming RANGE_TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_RANGE, return nonzero if 8711 ENCODING_TYPE, a type following the GNAT conventions for discrete 8712 type encodings, only carries redundant information. */ 8713 8714 static int 8715 ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (struct type *range_type, 8716 struct type *encoding_type) 8717 { 8718 struct type *fixed_range_type; 8719 const char *bounds_str; 8720 int n; 8721 LONGEST lo, hi; 8722 8723 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (range_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE); 8724 8725 if (TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (range_type)) 8726 != TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (encoding_type))) 8727 { 8728 /* The compiler probably used a simple base type to describe 8729 the range type instead of the range's actual base type, 8730 expecting us to get the real base type from the encoding 8731 anyway. In this situation, the encoding cannot be ignored 8732 as redundant. */ 8733 return 0; 8734 } 8735 8736 if (is_dynamic_type (range_type)) 8737 return 0; 8738 8739 if (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type) == NULL) 8740 return 0; 8741 8742 bounds_str = strstr (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type), "___XDLU_"); 8743 if (bounds_str == NULL) 8744 return 0; 8745 8746 n = 8; /* Skip "___XDLU_". */ 8747 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &lo, &n)) 8748 return 0; 8749 if (TYPE_LOW_BOUND (range_type) != lo) 8750 return 0; 8751 8752 n += 2; /* Skip the "__" separator between the two bounds. */ 8753 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &hi, &n)) 8754 return 0; 8755 if (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (range_type) != hi) 8756 return 0; 8757 8758 return 1; 8759 } 8760 8761 /* Given the array type ARRAY_TYPE, return nonzero if DESC_TYPE, 8762 a type following the GNAT encoding for describing array type 8763 indices, only carries redundant information. */ 8764 8765 static int 8766 ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (struct type *array_type, 8767 struct type *desc_type) 8768 { 8769 struct type *this_layer = check_typedef (array_type); 8770 int i; 8771 8772 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (desc_type); i++) 8773 { 8774 if (!ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (this_layer), 8775 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, i))) 8776 return 0; 8777 this_layer = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (this_layer)); 8778 } 8779 8780 return 1; 8781 } 8782 8783 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value 8784 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any 8785 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that 8786 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes 8787 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is 8788 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over 8789 varsize_limit. */ 8790 8791 static struct type * 8792 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval, 8793 int ignore_too_big) 8794 { 8795 struct type *index_type_desc; 8796 struct type *result; 8797 int constrained_packed_array_p; 8798 static const char *xa_suffix = "___XA"; 8799 8800 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0); 8801 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0)) 8802 return type0; 8803 8804 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0); 8805 if (constrained_packed_array_p) 8806 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0); 8807 8808 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, xa_suffix); 8809 8810 /* As mentioned in exp_dbug.ads, for non bit-packed arrays an 8811 encoding suffixed with 'P' may still be generated. If so, 8812 it should be used to find the XA type. */ 8813 8814 if (index_type_desc == NULL) 8815 { 8816 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type0); 8817 8818 if (type_name != NULL) 8819 { 8820 const int len = strlen (type_name); 8821 char *name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (xa_suffix)); 8822 8823 if (type_name[len - 1] == 'P') 8824 { 8825 strcpy (name, type_name); 8826 strcpy (name + len - 1, xa_suffix); 8827 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type0, name); 8828 } 8829 } 8830 } 8831 8832 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc); 8833 if (index_type_desc != NULL 8834 && ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (type0, index_type_desc)) 8835 { 8836 /* Ignore this ___XA parallel type, as it does not bring any 8837 useful information. This allows us to avoid creating fixed 8838 versions of the array's index types, which would be identical 8839 to the original ones. This, in turn, can also help avoid 8840 the creation of fixed versions of the array itself. */ 8841 index_type_desc = NULL; 8842 } 8843 8844 if (index_type_desc == NULL) 8845 { 8846 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)); 8847 8848 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never 8849 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed 8850 debugging data. */ 8851 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type. 8852 We're not providing the address of an element here, 8853 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do 8854 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of 8855 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all 8856 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of 8857 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to 8858 consult the object tag. */ 8859 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1); 8860 8861 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with 8862 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array 8863 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */ 8864 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p) 8865 result = type0; 8866 else 8867 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0), 8868 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)); 8869 } 8870 else 8871 { 8872 int i; 8873 struct type *elt_type0; 8874 8875 elt_type0 = type0; 8876 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1) 8877 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0); 8878 8879 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never 8880 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed 8881 debugging data. */ 8882 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type. 8883 We're not providing the address of an element here, 8884 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do 8885 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of 8886 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all 8887 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of 8888 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to 8889 consult the object tag. */ 8890 result = 8891 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1); 8892 8893 elt_type0 = type0; 8894 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1) 8895 { 8896 struct type *range_type = 8897 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval); 8898 8899 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0), 8900 result, range_type); 8901 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0); 8902 } 8903 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit) 8904 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit")); 8905 } 8906 8907 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when 8908 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been 8909 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */ 8910 TYPE_NAME (result) = TYPE_NAME (type0); 8911 8912 if (constrained_packed_array_p) 8913 { 8914 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original 8915 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the 8916 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array 8917 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */ 8918 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result)); 8919 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0); 8920 8921 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0); 8922 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT; 8923 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize) 8924 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++; 8925 } 8926 8927 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1; 8928 return result; 8929 } 8930 8931 8932 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components) 8933 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS) 8934 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0, 8935 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at 8936 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants. 8937 8938 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function 8939 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual 8940 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the 8941 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type. 8942 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */ 8943 8944 static struct type * 8945 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 8946 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag) 8947 { 8948 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 8949 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 8950 { 8951 default: 8952 return type; 8953 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT: 8954 { 8955 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type); 8956 struct type *fixed_record_type = 8957 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL); 8958 8959 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address, 8960 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual 8961 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record 8962 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields 8963 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on 8964 them). */ 8965 8966 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0)) 8967 { 8968 struct value *tag = 8969 value_tag_from_contents_and_address 8970 (fixed_record_type, 8971 valaddr, 8972 address); 8973 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag); 8974 struct value *obj = 8975 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type, 8976 valaddr, 8977 address); 8978 fixed_record_type = value_type (obj); 8979 if (real_type != NULL) 8980 return to_fixed_record_type 8981 (real_type, NULL, 8982 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL); 8983 } 8984 8985 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable. 8986 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */ 8987 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL) 8988 { 8989 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type); 8990 char *xvz_name 8991 = (char *) alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */); 8992 int xvz_found = 0; 8993 LONGEST size; 8994 8995 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name); 8996 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found); 8997 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size) 8998 { 8999 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type); 9000 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size; 9001 9002 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have 9003 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and 9004 apparently it is something that is hard to fix. 9005 9006 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition 9007 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us 9008 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we 9009 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type 9010 definition. 9011 9012 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are 9013 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble 9014 when using this type to create new types targeting it. 9015 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check 9016 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace 9017 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn, 9018 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too. 9019 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size 9020 of the array is computed from the number of elements in 9021 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */ 9022 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0; 9023 } 9024 } 9025 return fixed_record_type; 9026 } 9027 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY: 9028 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1); 9029 case TYPE_CODE_UNION: 9030 if (dval == NULL) 9031 return type; 9032 else 9033 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval); 9034 } 9035 } 9036 9037 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type 9038 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed. 9039 9040 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between 9041 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same 9042 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as 9043 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering: 9044 9045 type String_Access is access String; 9046 S1 : String_Access := null; 9047 9048 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But 9049 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1, 9050 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address 9051 instead. 9052 9053 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that 9054 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before 9055 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */ 9056 9057 struct type * 9058 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr, 9059 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag) 9060 9061 { 9062 struct type *fixed_type = 9063 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag); 9064 9065 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE, 9066 then preserve the typedef layer. 9067 9068 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of 9069 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer 9070 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags 9071 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its 9072 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return 9073 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more 9074 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done. 9075 9076 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is 9077 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers. 9078 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer 9079 only in that situation. But this seems unecessary so far, probably 9080 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere. 9081 */ 9082 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF 9083 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type)) 9084 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type))) 9085 return type; 9086 9087 return fixed_type; 9088 } 9089 9090 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to 9091 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */ 9092 9093 static struct type * 9094 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0) 9095 { 9096 struct type *type; 9097 9098 if (type0 == NULL) 9099 return NULL; 9100 9101 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0)) 9102 return type0; 9103 9104 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0); 9105 9106 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0)) 9107 { 9108 default: 9109 return type0; 9110 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT: 9111 type = dynamic_template_type (type0); 9112 if (type != NULL) 9113 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type); 9114 else 9115 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0); 9116 case TYPE_CODE_UNION: 9117 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU"); 9118 if (type != NULL) 9119 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type); 9120 else 9121 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0); 9122 } 9123 } 9124 9125 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */ 9126 9127 static struct type * 9128 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type) 9129 { 9130 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type)) 9131 { 9132 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0); 9133 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL) 9134 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type); 9135 9136 return static_unwrap_type (type1); 9137 } 9138 else 9139 { 9140 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type); 9141 9142 if (raw_real_type == type) 9143 return type; 9144 else 9145 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type); 9146 } 9147 } 9148 9149 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require 9150 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example, 9151 type Foo; 9152 type FooP is access Foo; 9153 V: FooP; 9154 type Foo is array ...; 9155 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing 9156 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a 9157 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is 9158 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */ 9159 9160 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one 9161 exists, otherwise TYPE. */ 9162 9163 struct type * 9164 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type) 9165 { 9166 if (type == NULL) 9167 return NULL; 9168 9169 /* If our type is a typedef type of a fat pointer, then we're done. 9170 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is 9171 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent 9172 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types 9173 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */ 9174 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF 9175 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type))) 9176 return type; 9177 9178 type = check_typedef (type); 9179 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM 9180 || !TYPE_STUB (type) 9181 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL) 9182 return type; 9183 else 9184 { 9185 const char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type); 9186 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name); 9187 9188 if (type1 == NULL) 9189 return type; 9190 9191 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with 9192 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array 9193 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case, 9194 strip the typedef layer. */ 9195 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 9196 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1); 9197 9198 return type1; 9199 } 9200 } 9201 9202 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by 9203 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly 9204 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard 9205 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant 9206 creation of struct values]. */ 9207 9208 static struct value * 9209 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address, 9210 struct value *val0) 9211 { 9212 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1); 9213 9214 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL) 9215 return val0; 9216 else 9217 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address); 9218 } 9219 9220 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type 9221 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new 9222 value. */ 9223 9224 struct value * 9225 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val) 9226 { 9227 val = unwrap_value (val); 9228 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val), 9229 value_address (val), 9230 val); 9231 return val; 9232 } 9233 9234 9235 /* Attributes */ 9236 9237 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names. 9238 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */ 9239 9240 static const char *attribute_names[] = { 9241 "<?>", 9242 9243 "first", 9244 "last", 9245 "length", 9246 "image", 9247 "max", 9248 "min", 9249 "modulus", 9250 "pos", 9251 "size", 9252 "tag", 9253 "val", 9254 0 9255 }; 9256 9257 const char * 9258 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n) 9259 { 9260 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL) 9261 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1]; 9262 else 9263 return attribute_names[0]; 9264 } 9265 9266 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */ 9267 9268 static LONGEST 9269 pos_atr (struct value *arg) 9270 { 9271 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg); 9272 struct type *type = value_type (val); 9273 LONGEST result; 9274 9275 if (!discrete_type_p (type)) 9276 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types")); 9277 9278 if (!discrete_position (type, value_as_long (val), &result)) 9279 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS")); 9280 9281 return result; 9282 } 9283 9284 static struct value * 9285 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg) 9286 { 9287 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg)); 9288 } 9289 9290 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */ 9291 9292 static struct value * 9293 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg) 9294 { 9295 if (!discrete_type_p (type)) 9296 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types")); 9297 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg))) 9298 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument")); 9299 9300 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 9301 { 9302 long pos = value_as_long (arg); 9303 9304 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type)) 9305 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range")); 9306 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos)); 9307 } 9308 else 9309 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg)); 9310 } 9311 9312 9313 /* Evaluation */ 9314 9315 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type. 9316 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character; 9317 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */ 9318 9319 int 9320 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type) 9321 { 9322 const char *name; 9323 9324 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is, 9325 and don't check any further. */ 9326 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR) 9327 return 1; 9328 9329 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type 9330 with a known character type name. */ 9331 name = ada_type_name (type); 9332 return (name != NULL 9333 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT 9334 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) 9335 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0 9336 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0 9337 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0 9338 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0)); 9339 } 9340 9341 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */ 9342 9343 int 9344 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type) 9345 { 9346 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 9347 if (type != NULL 9348 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR 9349 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type) 9350 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)) 9351 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1) 9352 { 9353 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1); 9354 9355 return ada_is_character_type (elttype); 9356 } 9357 else 9358 return 0; 9359 } 9360 9361 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given 9362 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly, 9363 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset 9364 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case 9365 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around 9366 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead. 9367 9368 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types. 9369 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */ 9370 static int trust_pad_over_xvs = 1; 9371 9372 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the 9373 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a 9374 distinctive name. */ 9375 9376 int 9377 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type) 9378 { 9379 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 9380 9381 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL) 9382 return 0; 9383 9384 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 9385 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1 9386 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0); 9387 } 9388 9389 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return 9390 the parallel type. */ 9391 9392 struct type * 9393 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type) 9394 { 9395 struct type *real_type_namer; 9396 struct type *raw_real_type; 9397 9398 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 9399 return raw_type; 9400 9401 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type)) 9402 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type. 9403 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should 9404 simply ignore it. 9405 9406 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner 9407 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner 9408 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and 9409 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result, 9410 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type. 9411 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal 9412 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes 9413 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */ 9414 return raw_type; 9415 9416 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS"); 9417 if (real_type_namer == NULL 9418 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 9419 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1) 9420 return raw_type; 9421 9422 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF) 9423 { 9424 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be 9425 looked up by name. We prefer the newer enconding because it is 9426 more efficient. */ 9427 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0)); 9428 if (raw_real_type == NULL) 9429 return raw_type; 9430 else 9431 return raw_real_type; 9432 } 9433 9434 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */ 9435 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)); 9436 } 9437 9438 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */ 9439 9440 struct type * 9441 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type) 9442 { 9443 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type)) 9444 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0)); 9445 else 9446 return ada_get_base_type (type); 9447 } 9448 9449 9450 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR 9451 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */ 9452 9453 const gdb_byte * 9454 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr) 9455 { 9456 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type)) 9457 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0), 9458 valaddr + 9459 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 9460 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT); 9461 else 9462 return valaddr; 9463 } 9464 9465 9466 9467 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded 9468 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */ 9469 const char * 9470 ada_enum_name (const char *name) 9471 { 9472 static char *result; 9473 static size_t result_len = 0; 9474 const char *tmp; 9475 9476 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name: 9477 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip 9478 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts 9479 right after that dot. 9480 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler 9481 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores, 9482 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is 9483 of the form "__" followed by digits. */ 9484 9485 tmp = strrchr (name, '.'); 9486 if (tmp != NULL) 9487 name = tmp + 1; 9488 else 9489 { 9490 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL) 9491 { 9492 if (isdigit (tmp[2])) 9493 break; 9494 else 9495 name = tmp + 2; 9496 } 9497 } 9498 9499 if (name[0] == 'Q') 9500 { 9501 int v; 9502 9503 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W') 9504 { 9505 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1) 9506 return name; 9507 } 9508 else 9509 return name; 9510 9511 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16); 9512 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v)) 9513 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v); 9514 else if (name[1] == 'U') 9515 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v); 9516 else 9517 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v); 9518 9519 return result; 9520 } 9521 else 9522 { 9523 tmp = strstr (name, "__"); 9524 if (tmp == NULL) 9525 tmp = strstr (name, "$"); 9526 if (tmp != NULL) 9527 { 9528 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1); 9529 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name); 9530 result[tmp - name] = '\0'; 9531 return result; 9532 } 9533 9534 return name; 9535 } 9536 } 9537 9538 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for 9539 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated 9540 expression. */ 9541 9542 static struct value * 9543 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos) 9544 { 9545 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS); 9546 } 9547 9548 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the 9549 value it wraps. */ 9550 9551 static struct value * 9552 unwrap_value (struct value *val) 9553 { 9554 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)); 9555 9556 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type)) 9557 { 9558 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0); 9559 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v)); 9560 9561 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL) 9562 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type); 9563 9564 return unwrap_value (v); 9565 } 9566 else 9567 { 9568 struct type *raw_real_type = 9569 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type)); 9570 9571 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is 9572 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */ 9573 if ((type == raw_real_type) 9574 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL) 9575 return val; 9576 9577 return 9578 coerce_unspec_val_to_type 9579 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0, 9580 value_address (val), 9581 NULL, 1)); 9582 } 9583 } 9584 9585 static struct value * 9586 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg) 9587 { 9588 LONGEST val; 9589 9590 if (type == value_type (arg)) 9591 return arg; 9592 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg))) 9593 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, 9594 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg), 9595 value_as_long (arg))); 9596 else 9597 { 9598 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg); 9599 9600 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd); 9601 } 9602 9603 return value_from_longest (type, val); 9604 } 9605 9606 static struct value * 9607 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg) 9608 { 9609 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg), 9610 value_as_long (arg)); 9611 9612 return value_from_double (type, val); 9613 } 9614 9615 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays 9616 contain the same number of elements. */ 9617 9618 static int 9619 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2) 9620 { 9621 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2; 9622 9623 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of 9624 the two arrays match. */ 9625 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1) 9626 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2)) 9627 error (_("unable to determine array bounds")); 9628 9629 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit 9630 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference 9631 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */ 9632 if (lo1 > hi1) 9633 hi1 = lo1 - 1; 9634 if (lo2 > hi2) 9635 hi2 = lo2 - 1; 9636 9637 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2); 9638 } 9639 9640 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents 9641 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral 9642 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this 9643 means that the returned array is built by casting each element 9644 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */ 9645 9646 static struct value * 9647 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val) 9648 { 9649 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 9650 LONGEST lo, hi; 9651 struct value *res; 9652 LONGEST i; 9653 9654 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and 9655 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size 9656 of type's element. */ 9657 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY); 9658 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))); 9659 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY); 9660 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val)))); 9661 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) 9662 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val)))); 9663 9664 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi)) 9665 error (_("unable to determine array bounds")); 9666 9667 res = allocate_value (type); 9668 9669 /* Promote each array element. */ 9670 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++) 9671 { 9672 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i)); 9673 9674 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)), 9675 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)); 9676 } 9677 9678 return res; 9679 } 9680 9681 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and 9682 return the converted value. */ 9683 9684 static struct value * 9685 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val) 9686 { 9687 struct type *type2 = value_type (val); 9688 9689 if (type == type2) 9690 return val; 9691 9692 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2); 9693 type = ada_check_typedef (type); 9694 9695 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 9696 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 9697 { 9698 val = ada_value_ind (val); 9699 type2 = value_type (val); 9700 } 9701 9702 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 9703 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 9704 { 9705 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2)) 9706 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length")); 9707 9708 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) 9709 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)) 9710 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)) 9711 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))) 9712 { 9713 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to 9714 a wider type. */ 9715 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val); 9716 } 9717 9718 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)) 9719 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))) 9720 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment")); 9721 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type); 9722 } 9723 return val; 9724 } 9725 9726 static struct value * 9727 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op) 9728 { 9729 struct value *val; 9730 struct type *type1, *type2; 9731 LONGEST v, v1, v2; 9732 9733 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1); 9734 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2); 9735 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1))); 9736 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2))); 9737 9738 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT 9739 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT) 9740 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op); 9741 9742 switch (op) 9743 { 9744 case BINOP_MOD: 9745 case BINOP_DIV: 9746 case BINOP_REM: 9747 break; 9748 default: 9749 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op); 9750 } 9751 9752 v2 = value_as_long (arg2); 9753 if (v2 == 0) 9754 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op)); 9755 9756 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD) 9757 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op); 9758 9759 v1 = value_as_long (arg1); 9760 switch (op) 9761 { 9762 case BINOP_DIV: 9763 v = v1 / v2; 9764 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0) 9765 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1; 9766 break; 9767 case BINOP_REM: 9768 v = v1 % v2; 9769 if (v * v1 < 0) 9770 v -= v2; 9771 break; 9772 default: 9773 /* Should not reach this point. */ 9774 v = 0; 9775 } 9776 9777 val = allocate_value (type1); 9778 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val), 9779 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)), 9780 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v); 9781 return val; 9782 } 9783 9784 static int 9785 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2) 9786 { 9787 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1)) 9788 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2))) 9789 { 9790 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before 9791 we attempt to perform the comparison. */ 9792 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); 9793 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2); 9794 9795 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1); 9796 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2); 9797 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 9798 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 9799 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array")); 9800 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose 9801 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits) 9802 and do not have user-defined equality. */ 9803 return 9804 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2)) 9805 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2), 9806 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0; 9807 } 9808 return value_equal (arg1, arg2); 9809 } 9810 9811 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at 9812 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an 9813 OP_AGGREGATE. */ 9814 9815 static int 9816 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc) 9817 { 9818 int n, m, i; 9819 9820 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst; 9821 pc += 3; 9822 n = 0; 9823 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1) 9824 { 9825 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode) 9826 { 9827 default: 9828 n += 1; 9829 break; 9830 case OP_CHOICES: 9831 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst; 9832 break; 9833 } 9834 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP); 9835 } 9836 return n; 9837 } 9838 9839 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth 9840 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past 9841 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does 9842 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless 9843 LHS == CONTAINER). */ 9844 9845 static void 9846 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index, 9847 struct expression *exp, int *pos) 9848 { 9849 struct value *mark = value_mark (); 9850 struct value *elt; 9851 9852 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 9853 { 9854 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 9855 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index); 9856 9857 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val)); 9858 } 9859 else 9860 { 9861 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs)); 9862 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt); 9863 } 9864 9865 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE) 9866 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL); 9867 else 9868 value_assign_to_component (container, elt, 9869 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, 9870 EVAL_NORMAL)); 9871 9872 value_free_to_mark (mark); 9873 } 9874 9875 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array 9876 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment 9877 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the 9878 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an 9879 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify 9880 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of 9881 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */ 9882 9883 static struct value * 9884 assign_aggregate (struct value *container, 9885 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp, 9886 int *pos, enum noside noside) 9887 { 9888 struct type *lhs_type; 9889 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst; 9890 LONGEST low_index, high_index; 9891 int num_specs; 9892 LONGEST *indices; 9893 int max_indices, num_indices; 9894 int i; 9895 9896 *pos += 3; 9897 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL) 9898 { 9899 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1) 9900 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside); 9901 return container; 9902 } 9903 9904 container = ada_coerce_ref (container); 9905 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container))) 9906 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container); 9907 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs); 9908 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs)) 9909 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue.")); 9910 9911 lhs_type = value_type (lhs); 9912 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type)) 9913 { 9914 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs); 9915 lhs_type = value_type (lhs); 9916 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type); 9917 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type); 9918 } 9919 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT) 9920 { 9921 low_index = 0; 9922 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1; 9923 } 9924 else 9925 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record.")); 9926 9927 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3); 9928 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4; 9929 indices = XALLOCAVEC (LONGEST, max_indices); 9930 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1; 9931 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1; 9932 num_indices = 4; 9933 9934 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1) 9935 { 9936 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode) 9937 { 9938 case OP_CHOICES: 9939 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices, 9940 &num_indices, max_indices, 9941 low_index, high_index); 9942 break; 9943 case OP_POSITIONAL: 9944 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices, 9945 &num_indices, max_indices, 9946 low_index, high_index); 9947 break; 9948 case OP_OTHERS: 9949 if (i != n-1) 9950 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause")); 9951 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices, 9952 num_indices, low_index, high_index); 9953 break; 9954 default: 9955 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause")); 9956 } 9957 } 9958 9959 return container; 9960 } 9961 9962 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL 9963 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that 9964 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the 9965 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1] 9966 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for 9967 assign_aggregate. */ 9968 static void 9969 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container, 9970 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp, 9971 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices, 9972 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high) 9973 { 9974 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low; 9975 9976 if (ind - 1 == high) 9977 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored.")); 9978 if (ind <= high) 9979 { 9980 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices); 9981 *pos += 3; 9982 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos); 9983 } 9984 else 9985 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 9986 } 9987 9988 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES 9989 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that 9990 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned 9991 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as 9992 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */ 9993 static void 9994 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container, 9995 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp, 9996 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices, 9997 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high) 9998 { 9999 int j; 10000 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst); 10001 int choice_pos, expr_pc; 10002 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs)); 10003 10004 choice_pos = *pos += 3; 10005 10006 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1) 10007 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 10008 expr_pc = *pos; 10009 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 10010 10011 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1) 10012 { 10013 LONGEST lower, upper; 10014 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode; 10015 10016 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE) 10017 { 10018 choice_pos += 1; 10019 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, 10020 EVAL_NORMAL)); 10021 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, 10022 EVAL_NORMAL)); 10023 } 10024 else if (is_array) 10025 { 10026 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, 10027 EVAL_NORMAL)); 10028 upper = lower; 10029 } 10030 else 10031 { 10032 int ind; 10033 const char *name; 10034 10035 switch (op) 10036 { 10037 case OP_NAME: 10038 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string; 10039 break; 10040 case OP_VAR_VALUE: 10041 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol); 10042 break; 10043 default: 10044 error (_("Invalid record component association.")); 10045 } 10046 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP); 10047 ind = 0; 10048 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0, 10049 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind)) 10050 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name); 10051 lower = upper = ind; 10052 } 10053 10054 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high)) 10055 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds.")); 10056 10057 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices, 10058 max_indices); 10059 while (lower <= upper) 10060 { 10061 int pos1; 10062 10063 pos1 = expr_pc; 10064 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1); 10065 lower += 1; 10066 } 10067 } 10068 } 10069 10070 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in 10071 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that 10072 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned 10073 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the 10074 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */ 10075 static void 10076 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container, 10077 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp, 10078 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices, 10079 LONGEST low, LONGEST high) 10080 { 10081 int i; 10082 int expr_pc = *pos + 1; 10083 10084 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2) 10085 { 10086 LONGEST ind; 10087 10088 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1) 10089 { 10090 int localpos; 10091 10092 localpos = expr_pc; 10093 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos); 10094 } 10095 } 10096 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 10097 } 10098 10099 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals 10100 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ], 10101 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds 10102 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */ 10103 static void 10104 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high, 10105 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size) 10106 { 10107 int i, j; 10108 10109 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) { 10110 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1]) 10111 { 10112 int kh; 10113 10114 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2) 10115 if (high < indices[kh]) 10116 break; 10117 if (low < indices[i]) 10118 indices[i] = low; 10119 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1]; 10120 if (high > indices[i + 1]) 10121 indices[i + 1] = high; 10122 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh); 10123 *size -= kh - i - 2; 10124 return; 10125 } 10126 else if (high < indices[i]) 10127 break; 10128 } 10129 10130 if (*size == max_size) 10131 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components.")); 10132 *size += 2; 10133 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1) 10134 indices[j] = indices[j - 2]; 10135 indices[i] = low; 10136 indices[i + 1] = high; 10137 } 10138 10139 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2 10140 is different. */ 10141 10142 static struct value * 10143 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside) 10144 { 10145 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2))) 10146 return arg2; 10147 10148 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type)) 10149 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2)); 10150 10151 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2))) 10152 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2); 10153 10154 return value_cast (type, arg2); 10155 } 10156 10157 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result. 10158 ------------------------------------------------------ 10159 10160 1. Introduction: 10161 ---------------- 10162 10163 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value. 10164 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which 10165 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation, 10166 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the 10167 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of 10168 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very 10169 similar. 10170 10171 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities 10172 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for 10173 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic. 10174 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example 10175 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time. 10176 10177 The following description is a general guide as to what should be 10178 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression 10179 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic 10180 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the 10181 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads 10182 in the GNAT sources. 10183 10184 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its 10185 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right 10186 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular 10187 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is 10188 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments 10189 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it. 10190 10191 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case: 10192 ----------------------------------------- 10193 10194 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may 10195 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically 10196 known. Consider for instance a variant record: 10197 10198 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record 10199 case Empty is 10200 when True => null; 10201 when False => Value : Integer; 10202 end case; 10203 end record; 10204 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1); 10205 No : Rec := (empty => True); 10206 10207 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the 10208 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging 10209 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to 10210 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create 10211 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object. 10212 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object, 10213 which means creating its associated fixed type. 10214 10215 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed 10216 type would look like this: 10217 10218 type Rec is record 10219 Empty : Boolean; 10220 Value : Integer; 10221 end record; 10222 10223 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type 10224 would become: 10225 10226 type Rec is record 10227 Empty : Boolean; 10228 end record; 10229 10230 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity 10231 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type, 10232 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are 10233 two possible cases: Arrays, and records. 10234 10235 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays: 10236 --------------------- 10237 10238 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds, 10239 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array 10240 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements 10241 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array, 10242 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one 10243 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do 10244 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size 10245 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having 10246 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later, 10247 when (if) necessary. 10248 10249 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same 10250 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if 10251 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element 10252 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec: 10253 10254 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec; 10255 10256 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different 10257 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant. 10258 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains 10259 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using 10260 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine 10261 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by 10262 the size of each element). 10263 10264 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element 10265 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations: 10266 10267 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is 10268 Length : Integer; 10269 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size); 10270 end record; 10271 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80); 10272 10273 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of 10274 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which 10275 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable. 10276 10277 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler 10278 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not 10279 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note 10280 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate 10281 these wrapper types. 10282 10283 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically 10284 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size, 10285 and the array element should remain unfixed. 10286 10287 But there are cases when this size is not statically known. 10288 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable: 10289 10290 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer; 10291 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record 10292 Data : Dynamic; 10293 case Has_Length is 10294 when True => Length : Integer; 10295 when False => null; 10296 end case; 10297 end record; 10298 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper; 10299 10300 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True, 10301 Data => (others => 17), 10302 Length => 1)); 10303 10304 10305 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an 10306 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically 10307 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable. 10308 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should 10309 be used for the fixed array. 10310 10311 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects: 10312 ---------------------------------- 10313 10314 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic 10315 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated 10316 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of 10317 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed 10318 type of each of these components. 10319 10320 Consider for instance the example: 10321 10322 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record 10323 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size); 10324 Length : Natural; 10325 end record; 10326 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10); 10327 10328 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size 10329 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size 10330 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String, 10331 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant 10332 record requires us to fix each of its components. 10333 10334 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component 10335 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type 10336 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen 10337 (assuming type Rec above): 10338 10339 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record 10340 First : Rec; 10341 After : Integer; 10342 case Big is 10343 when True => Another : Integer; 10344 when False => null; 10345 end case; 10346 end record; 10347 My_Container : Container := (Big => False, 10348 First => (Empty => True), 10349 After => 42); 10350 10351 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First, 10352 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just 10353 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant 10354 in this case. 10355 10356 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm 10357 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field 10358 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print 10359 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would 10360 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the 10361 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has 10362 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller 10363 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would 10364 compute the wrong offset of field After. 10365 10366 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic 10367 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in 10368 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size 10369 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs 10370 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise, 10371 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be 10372 observed with the following type declarations: 10373 10374 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7; 10375 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal; 10376 pragma Pack (Octal_Array); 10377 10378 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record 10379 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size); 10380 Length : Integer; 10381 end record; 10382 10383 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs 10384 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type. 10385 10386 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity: 10387 ---------------------------------------------------------- 10388 10389 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed 10390 thus far, be actually fixed? 10391 10392 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance 10393 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component 10394 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value 10395 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets 10396 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be 10397 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting 10398 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should 10399 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array! 10400 10401 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and 10402 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size 10403 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing 10404 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based 10405 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch 10406 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is 10407 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our 10408 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read 10409 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */ 10410 10411 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure 10412 for the Ada language. */ 10413 10414 static struct value * 10415 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp, 10416 int *pos, enum noside noside) 10417 { 10418 enum exp_opcode op; 10419 int tem; 10420 int pc; 10421 int preeval_pos; 10422 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3; 10423 struct type *type; 10424 int nargs, oplen; 10425 struct value **argvec; 10426 10427 pc = *pos; 10428 *pos += 1; 10429 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode; 10430 10431 switch (op) 10432 { 10433 default: 10434 *pos -= 1; 10435 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside); 10436 10437 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL) 10438 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1); 10439 10440 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided, 10441 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because 10442 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is 10443 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed 10444 types in Ada have different representations. 10445 10446 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG 10447 ourselves. */ 10448 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL) 10449 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside); 10450 10451 return arg1; 10452 10453 case OP_STRING: 10454 { 10455 struct value *result; 10456 10457 *pos -= 1; 10458 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside); 10459 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from 10460 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */ 10461 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING) 10462 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY; 10463 return result; 10464 } 10465 10466 case UNOP_CAST: 10467 (*pos) += 2; 10468 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type; 10469 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside); 10470 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10471 goto nosideret; 10472 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside); 10473 return arg1; 10474 10475 case UNOP_QUAL: 10476 (*pos) += 2; 10477 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type; 10478 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside); 10479 10480 case BINOP_ASSIGN: 10481 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10482 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE) 10483 { 10484 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside); 10485 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10486 return arg1; 10487 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1); 10488 } 10489 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1, 10490 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable. 10491 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs 10492 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */ 10493 type = value_type (arg1); 10494 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar) 10495 type = NULL; 10496 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside); 10497 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10498 return arg1; 10499 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))) 10500 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2); 10501 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2))) 10502 error 10503 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables")); 10504 else 10505 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2); 10506 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2); 10507 10508 case BINOP_ADD: 10509 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside); 10510 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside); 10511 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10512 goto nosideret; 10513 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10514 return (value_from_longest 10515 (value_type (arg1), 10516 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2))); 10517 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10518 return (value_from_longest 10519 (value_type (arg2), 10520 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2))); 10521 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)) 10522 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2))) 10523 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2)) 10524 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type")); 10525 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first 10526 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if 10527 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */ 10528 type = value_type (arg1); 10529 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 10530 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 10531 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10532 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD)); 10533 10534 case BINOP_SUB: 10535 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside); 10536 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside); 10537 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10538 goto nosideret; 10539 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10540 return (value_from_longest 10541 (value_type (arg1), 10542 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2))); 10543 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10544 return (value_from_longest 10545 (value_type (arg2), 10546 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2))); 10547 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)) 10548 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2))) 10549 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2)) 10550 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction " 10551 "must have the same type")); 10552 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first 10553 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if 10554 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */ 10555 type = value_type (arg1); 10556 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 10557 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 10558 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10559 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB)); 10560 10561 case BINOP_MUL: 10562 case BINOP_DIV: 10563 case BINOP_REM: 10564 case BINOP_MOD: 10565 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10566 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10567 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10568 goto nosideret; 10569 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10570 { 10571 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10572 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval); 10573 } 10574 else 10575 { 10576 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double; 10577 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))) 10578 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1); 10579 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2))) 10580 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2); 10581 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10582 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op); 10583 } 10584 10585 case BINOP_EQUAL: 10586 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL: 10587 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10588 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside); 10589 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10590 goto nosideret; 10591 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10592 tem = 0; 10593 else 10594 { 10595 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10596 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2); 10597 } 10598 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL) 10599 tem = !tem; 10600 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 10601 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem); 10602 10603 case UNOP_NEG: 10604 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10605 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10606 goto nosideret; 10607 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))) 10608 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1)); 10609 else 10610 { 10611 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1); 10612 return value_neg (arg1); 10613 } 10614 10615 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND: 10616 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR: 10617 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT: 10618 { 10619 struct value *val; 10620 10621 *pos -= 1; 10622 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside); 10623 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 10624 return value_cast (type, val); 10625 } 10626 10627 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND: 10628 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR: 10629 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR: 10630 { 10631 struct value *val; 10632 10633 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS); 10634 *pos = pc; 10635 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside); 10636 10637 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val); 10638 } 10639 10640 case OP_VAR_VALUE: 10641 *pos -= 1; 10642 10643 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10644 { 10645 *pos += 4; 10646 goto nosideret; 10647 } 10648 10649 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN) 10650 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a 10651 context other than a function call, in which case, it is 10652 invalid. */ 10653 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"), 10654 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)); 10655 10656 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10657 { 10658 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)); 10659 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle 10660 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but 10661 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types. 10662 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas 10663 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */ 10664 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0) 10665 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF 10666 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0))) 10667 { 10668 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real 10669 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the 10670 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's 10671 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object 10672 type from its tag. 10673 10674 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract 10675 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase 10676 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones. 10677 This can cause problems when trying to print the type 10678 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size: 10679 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order 10680 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description. 10681 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into 10682 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name, 10683 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor 10684 type in the type description. */ 10685 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL); 10686 10687 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF) 10688 { 10689 struct type *actual_type; 10690 10691 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1)); 10692 if (actual_type == NULL) 10693 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine 10694 the actual type from the tag, then use the static 10695 approximation that we just computed as a fallback. 10696 This can happen if the debugging information is 10697 incomplete, for instance. */ 10698 actual_type = type; 10699 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval); 10700 } 10701 else 10702 { 10703 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care 10704 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation 10705 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask 10706 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */ 10707 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); 10708 return value_ref (arg1, TYPE_CODE_REF); 10709 } 10710 } 10711 10712 /* Records and unions for which GNAT encodings have been 10713 generated need to be statically fixed as well. 10714 Otherwise, non-static fixing produces a type where 10715 all dynamic properties are removed, which prevents "ptype" 10716 from being able to completely describe the type. 10717 For instance, a case statement in a variant record would be 10718 replaced by the relevant components based on the actual 10719 value of the discriminants. */ 10720 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 10721 && dynamic_template_type (type) != NULL) 10722 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION 10723 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVU") != NULL)) 10724 { 10725 *pos += 4; 10726 return value_zero (to_static_fixed_type (type), not_lval); 10727 } 10728 } 10729 10730 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside); 10731 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1); 10732 10733 case OP_FUNCALL: 10734 (*pos) += 2; 10735 10736 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be 10737 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */ 10738 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 10739 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 2); 10740 10741 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE 10742 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN) 10743 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"), 10744 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol)); 10745 else 10746 { 10747 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1) 10748 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10749 argvec[tem] = 0; 10750 10751 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10752 goto nosideret; 10753 } 10754 10755 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type 10756 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0])))) 10757 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]); 10758 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 10759 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0) 10760 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and 10761 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further 10762 to do. */ 10763 ; 10764 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 10765 { 10766 /* Make sure we dereference references so that all the code below 10767 feels like it's really handling the referenced value. Wrapping 10768 types (for alignment) may be there, so make sure we strip them as 10769 well. */ 10770 argvec[0] = ada_to_fixed_value (coerce_ref (argvec[0])); 10771 } 10772 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 10773 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory) 10774 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]); 10775 10776 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0])); 10777 10778 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting 10779 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array 10780 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */ 10781 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) 10782 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type); 10783 10784 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10785 { 10786 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))) 10787 { 10788 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC: 10789 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 10790 break; 10791 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY: 10792 break; 10793 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT: 10794 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10795 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]); 10796 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 10797 break; 10798 default: 10799 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"), 10800 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0]))); 10801 break; 10802 } 10803 } 10804 10805 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 10806 { 10807 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC: 10808 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10809 { 10810 struct type *rtype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 10811 10812 if (TYPE_GNU_IFUNC (type)) 10813 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (rtype)); 10814 return allocate_value (rtype); 10815 } 10816 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1); 10817 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION: 10818 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10819 /* We don't know anything about what the internal 10820 function might return, but we have to return 10821 something. */ 10822 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 10823 not_lval); 10824 else 10825 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn, 10826 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1); 10827 10828 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT: 10829 { 10830 int arity; 10831 10832 arity = ada_array_arity (type); 10833 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs); 10834 if (type == NULL) 10835 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record")); 10836 if (arity != nargs) 10837 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity); 10838 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10839 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory); 10840 return 10841 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript 10842 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1)); 10843 } 10844 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY: 10845 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10846 { 10847 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs); 10848 if (type == NULL) 10849 error (_("element type of array unknown")); 10850 else 10851 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory); 10852 } 10853 return 10854 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript 10855 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]), 10856 nargs, argvec + 1)); 10857 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */ 10858 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10859 { 10860 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1); 10861 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs); 10862 if (type == NULL) 10863 error (_("element type of array unknown")); 10864 else 10865 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory); 10866 } 10867 return 10868 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], 10869 nargs, argvec + 1)); 10870 10871 default: 10872 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an " 10873 "array or function")); 10874 } 10875 10876 case TERNOP_SLICE: 10877 { 10878 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10879 struct value *low_bound_val = 10880 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10881 struct value *high_bound_val = 10882 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10883 LONGEST low_bound; 10884 LONGEST high_bound; 10885 10886 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val); 10887 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val); 10888 low_bound = value_as_long (low_bound_val); 10889 high_bound = value_as_long (high_bound_val); 10890 10891 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10892 goto nosideret; 10893 10894 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all 10895 the aligners. */ 10896 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF 10897 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))) 10898 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) = 10899 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))); 10900 10901 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array))) 10902 error (_("cannot slice a packed array")); 10903 10904 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue, 10905 convert to a pointer. */ 10906 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF 10907 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 10908 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory)) 10909 array = value_addr (array); 10910 10911 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS 10912 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef 10913 (value_type (array)))) 10914 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound); 10915 10916 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array); 10917 10918 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection, 10919 dereference the value until we get only one level. */ 10920 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 10921 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))) 10922 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)) 10923 array = value_ind (array); 10924 10925 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further, 10926 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target 10927 type later down the road if the debug info generated by 10928 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */ 10929 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array))) 10930 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array")); 10931 10932 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array))) 10933 == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 10934 { 10935 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)); 10936 10937 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10938 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound); 10939 else 10940 { 10941 struct type *arr_type0 = 10942 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1); 10943 10944 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0, 10945 longest_to_int (low_bound), 10946 longest_to_int (high_bound)); 10947 } 10948 } 10949 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10950 return array; 10951 else if (high_bound < low_bound) 10952 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound); 10953 else 10954 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound), 10955 longest_to_int (high_bound)); 10956 } 10957 10958 case UNOP_IN_RANGE: 10959 (*pos) += 2; 10960 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10961 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type); 10962 10963 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10964 goto nosideret; 10965 10966 switch (TYPE_CODE (type)) 10967 { 10968 default: 10969 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; " 10970 "always returns true")); 10971 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 10972 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1); 10973 10974 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE: 10975 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type)); 10976 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type)); 10977 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 10978 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3); 10979 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 10980 return 10981 value_from_longest (type, 10982 (value_less (arg1, arg3) 10983 || value_equal (arg1, arg3)) 10984 && (value_less (arg2, arg1) 10985 || value_equal (arg2, arg1))); 10986 } 10987 10988 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS: 10989 (*pos) += 2; 10990 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10991 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 10992 10993 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 10994 goto nosideret; 10995 10996 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 10997 { 10998 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 10999 return value_zero (type, not_lval); 11000 } 11001 11002 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 11003 11004 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range"); 11005 if (!type) 11006 type = value_type (arg1); 11007 11008 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1)); 11009 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0)); 11010 11011 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 11012 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3); 11013 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 11014 return 11015 value_from_longest (type, 11016 (value_less (arg1, arg3) 11017 || value_equal (arg1, arg3)) 11018 && (value_less (arg2, arg1) 11019 || value_equal (arg2, arg1))); 11020 11021 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE: 11022 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11023 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11024 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11025 11026 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11027 goto nosideret; 11028 11029 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 11030 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3); 11031 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch); 11032 return 11033 value_from_longest (type, 11034 (value_less (arg1, arg3) 11035 || value_equal (arg1, arg3)) 11036 && (value_less (arg2, arg1) 11037 || value_equal (arg2, arg1))); 11038 11039 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 11040 case OP_ATR_LAST: 11041 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 11042 { 11043 struct type *type_arg; 11044 11045 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE) 11046 { 11047 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 11048 arg1 = NULL; 11049 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type); 11050 } 11051 else 11052 { 11053 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11054 type_arg = NULL; 11055 } 11056 11057 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG) 11058 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op)); 11059 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst); 11060 *pos += 4; 11061 11062 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11063 goto nosideret; 11064 11065 if (type_arg == NULL) 11066 { 11067 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); 11068 11069 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1))) 11070 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1); 11071 11072 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH) 11073 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 11074 else 11075 { 11076 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem, 11077 ada_attribute_name (op)); 11078 if (type == NULL) 11079 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 11080 } 11081 11082 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11083 return allocate_value (type); 11084 11085 switch (op) 11086 { 11087 default: /* Should never happen. */ 11088 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered")); 11089 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 11090 return value_from_longest 11091 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0)); 11092 case OP_ATR_LAST: 11093 return value_from_longest 11094 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1)); 11095 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 11096 return value_from_longest 11097 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem)); 11098 } 11099 } 11100 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg)) 11101 { 11102 struct type *range_type; 11103 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg); 11104 11105 range_type = NULL; 11106 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM) 11107 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL); 11108 if (range_type == NULL) 11109 range_type = type_arg; 11110 switch (op) 11111 { 11112 default: 11113 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered")); 11114 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 11115 return value_from_longest 11116 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type)); 11117 case OP_ATR_LAST: 11118 return value_from_longest 11119 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type)); 11120 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 11121 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types")); 11122 } 11123 } 11124 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT) 11125 error (_("unimplemented type attribute")); 11126 else 11127 { 11128 LONGEST low, high; 11129 11130 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg)) 11131 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg); 11132 11133 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH) 11134 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 11135 else 11136 { 11137 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op)); 11138 if (type == NULL) 11139 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 11140 } 11141 11142 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11143 return allocate_value (type); 11144 11145 switch (op) 11146 { 11147 default: 11148 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered")); 11149 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 11150 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0); 11151 return value_from_longest (type, low); 11152 case OP_ATR_LAST: 11153 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1); 11154 return value_from_longest (type, high); 11155 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 11156 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0); 11157 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1); 11158 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1); 11159 } 11160 } 11161 } 11162 11163 case OP_ATR_TAG: 11164 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11165 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11166 goto nosideret; 11167 11168 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11169 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval); 11170 11171 return ada_value_tag (arg1); 11172 11173 case OP_ATR_MIN: 11174 case OP_ATR_MAX: 11175 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 11176 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11177 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11178 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11179 goto nosideret; 11180 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11181 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval); 11182 else 11183 { 11184 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 11185 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, 11186 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX); 11187 } 11188 11189 case OP_ATR_MODULUS: 11190 { 11191 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type); 11192 11193 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 11194 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11195 goto nosideret; 11196 11197 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg)) 11198 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type")); 11199 11200 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg), 11201 ada_modulus (type_arg)); 11202 } 11203 11204 11205 case OP_ATR_POS: 11206 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 11207 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11208 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11209 goto nosideret; 11210 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int; 11211 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11212 return value_zero (type, not_lval); 11213 else 11214 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1); 11215 11216 case OP_ATR_SIZE: 11217 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11218 type = value_type (arg1); 11219 11220 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since 11221 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object, 11222 not the size of the pointer. */ 11223 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF) 11224 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type); 11225 11226 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11227 goto nosideret; 11228 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11229 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval); 11230 else 11231 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 11232 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type)); 11233 11234 case OP_ATR_VAL: 11235 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP); 11236 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11237 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type; 11238 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11239 goto nosideret; 11240 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11241 return value_zero (type, not_lval); 11242 else 11243 return value_val_atr (type, arg1); 11244 11245 case BINOP_EXP: 11246 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11247 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11248 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11249 goto nosideret; 11250 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11251 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval); 11252 else 11253 { 11254 /* For integer exponentiation operations, 11255 only promote the first argument. */ 11256 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2))) 11257 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1); 11258 else 11259 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2); 11260 11261 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op); 11262 } 11263 11264 case UNOP_PLUS: 11265 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11266 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11267 goto nosideret; 11268 else 11269 return arg1; 11270 11271 case UNOP_ABS: 11272 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11273 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11274 goto nosideret; 11275 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1); 11276 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval))) 11277 return value_neg (arg1); 11278 else 11279 return arg1; 11280 11281 case UNOP_IND: 11282 preeval_pos = *pos; 11283 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11284 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11285 goto nosideret; 11286 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)); 11287 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11288 { 11289 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)) 11290 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */ 11291 { 11292 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0); 11293 11294 if (arrType == NULL) 11295 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer.")); 11296 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0); 11297 } 11298 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR 11299 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF 11300 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */ 11301 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY) 11302 { 11303 /* As mentioned in the OP_VAR_VALUE case, tagged types can 11304 only be determined by inspecting the object's tag. 11305 This means that we need to evaluate completely the 11306 expression in order to get its type. */ 11307 11308 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF 11309 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR) 11310 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)) 11311 { 11312 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos, 11313 EVAL_NORMAL); 11314 type = value_type (ada_value_ind (arg1)); 11315 } 11316 else 11317 { 11318 type = to_static_fixed_type 11319 (ada_aligned_type 11320 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))); 11321 } 11322 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type); 11323 return value_zero (type, lval_memory); 11324 } 11325 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT) 11326 { 11327 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */ 11328 if (expect_type == NULL) 11329 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 11330 lval_memory); 11331 else 11332 { 11333 expect_type = 11334 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type)); 11335 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory); 11336 } 11337 } 11338 else 11339 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value.")); 11340 } 11341 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */ 11342 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)); 11343 11344 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT) 11345 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given 11346 the expect_type, then use that as the target type. 11347 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */ 11348 { 11349 if (expect_type != NULL) 11350 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type), 11351 arg1)); 11352 else 11353 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 11354 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1)); 11355 } 11356 11357 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)) 11358 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */ 11359 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1); 11360 else 11361 return ada_value_ind (arg1); 11362 11363 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT: 11364 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 11365 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1); 11366 preeval_pos = *pos; 11367 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside); 11368 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11369 goto nosideret; 11370 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11371 { 11372 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1); 11373 11374 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1)) 11375 { 11376 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, 11377 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 11378 1, 1, NULL); 11379 11380 /* If the field is not found, check if it exists in the 11381 extension of this object's type. This means that we 11382 need to evaluate completely the expression. */ 11383 11384 if (type == NULL) 11385 { 11386 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos, 11387 EVAL_NORMAL); 11388 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, 11389 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 11390 0); 11391 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1); 11392 type = value_type (ada_to_fixed_value (arg1)); 11393 } 11394 } 11395 else 11396 type = 11397 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1, 11398 0, NULL); 11399 11400 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory); 11401 } 11402 else 11403 { 11404 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0); 11405 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1); 11406 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1); 11407 } 11408 11409 case OP_TYPE: 11410 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it 11411 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */ 11412 (*pos) += 2; 11413 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP) 11414 goto nosideret; 11415 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS) 11416 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type); 11417 else 11418 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression")); 11419 11420 case OP_AGGREGATE: 11421 case OP_CHOICES: 11422 case OP_OTHERS: 11423 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE: 11424 case OP_POSITIONAL: 11425 case OP_NAME: 11426 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL) 11427 switch (op) 11428 { 11429 case OP_NAME: 11430 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in " 11431 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string); 11432 case OP_AGGREGATE: 11433 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment")); 11434 default: 11435 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, 11436 _("aggregate apparently mangled")); 11437 } 11438 11439 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs); 11440 *pos += oplen - 1; 11441 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1) 11442 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside); 11443 goto nosideret; 11444 } 11445 11446 nosideret: 11447 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1); 11448 } 11449 11450 11451 /* Fixed point */ 11452 11453 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the 11454 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information. 11455 Otherwise, return NULL. */ 11456 11457 static const char * 11458 fixed_type_info (struct type *type) 11459 { 11460 const char *name = ada_type_name (type); 11461 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type); 11462 11463 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL) 11464 { 11465 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_"); 11466 11467 if (tail == NULL) 11468 return NULL; 11469 else 11470 return tail + 5; 11471 } 11472 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type) 11473 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)); 11474 else 11475 return NULL; 11476 } 11477 11478 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */ 11479 11480 int 11481 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type) 11482 { 11483 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL; 11484 } 11485 11486 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */ 11487 11488 int 11489 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type) 11490 { 11491 return (TYPE_NAME (type) 11492 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0); 11493 } 11494 11495 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point 11496 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the 11497 delta cannot be determined. */ 11498 11499 DOUBLEST 11500 ada_delta (struct type *type) 11501 { 11502 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type); 11503 DOUBLEST num, den; 11504 11505 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However, 11506 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted 11507 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */ 11508 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT, 11509 &num, &den) < 2) 11510 return -1.0; 11511 else 11512 return num / den; 11513 } 11514 11515 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling 11516 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */ 11517 11518 static DOUBLEST 11519 scaling_factor (struct type *type) 11520 { 11521 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type); 11522 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1; 11523 int n; 11524 11525 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However, 11526 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted 11527 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */ 11528 n = sscanf (encoding, 11529 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT 11530 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT, 11531 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1); 11532 11533 if (n < 2) 11534 return 1.0; 11535 else if (n == 4) 11536 return num1 / den1; 11537 else 11538 return num0 / den0; 11539 } 11540 11541 11542 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point 11543 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */ 11544 11545 DOUBLEST 11546 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x) 11547 { 11548 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type); 11549 } 11550 11551 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE 11552 corresponding to the value X. */ 11553 11554 LONGEST 11555 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x) 11556 { 11557 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5); 11558 } 11559 11560 11561 11562 /* Range types */ 11563 11564 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and 11565 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If 11566 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the 11567 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do 11568 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */ 11569 11570 static int 11571 scan_discrim_bound (const char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px, 11572 int *pnew_k) 11573 { 11574 static char *bound_buffer = NULL; 11575 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0; 11576 const char *pstart, *pend, *bound; 11577 struct value *bound_val; 11578 11579 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0') 11580 return 0; 11581 11582 pstart = str + k; 11583 pend = strstr (pstart, "__"); 11584 if (pend == NULL) 11585 { 11586 bound = pstart; 11587 k += strlen (bound); 11588 } 11589 else 11590 { 11591 int len = pend - pstart; 11592 11593 /* Strip __ and beyond. */ 11594 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, len + 1); 11595 strncpy (bound_buffer, pstart, len); 11596 bound_buffer[len] = '\0'; 11597 11598 bound = bound_buffer; 11599 k = pend - str; 11600 } 11601 11602 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval)); 11603 if (bound_val == NULL) 11604 return 0; 11605 11606 *px = value_as_long (bound_val); 11607 if (pnew_k != NULL) 11608 *pnew_k = k; 11609 return 1; 11610 } 11611 11612 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If 11613 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and 11614 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */ 11615 11616 static struct value * 11617 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg) 11618 { 11619 struct block_symbol *syms; 11620 int nsyms; 11621 11622 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN, 11623 &syms); 11624 11625 if (nsyms != 1) 11626 { 11627 if (err_msg == NULL) 11628 return 0; 11629 else 11630 error (("%s"), err_msg); 11631 } 11632 11633 return value_of_variable (syms[0].symbol, syms[0].block); 11634 } 11635 11636 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If 11637 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If 11638 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */ 11639 11640 LONGEST 11641 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag) 11642 { 11643 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0); 11644 11645 if (var_val == 0) 11646 { 11647 if (flag != NULL) 11648 *flag = 0; 11649 return 0; 11650 } 11651 else 11652 { 11653 if (flag != NULL) 11654 *flag = 1; 11655 return value_as_long (var_val); 11656 } 11657 } 11658 11659 11660 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named 11661 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated 11662 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions. 11663 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the 11664 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it 11665 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it 11666 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded 11667 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */ 11668 11669 static struct type * 11670 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval) 11671 { 11672 const char *name; 11673 struct type *base_type; 11674 const char *subtype_info; 11675 11676 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL); 11677 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL); 11678 11679 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) 11680 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type); 11681 else 11682 base_type = raw_type; 11683 11684 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type); 11685 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD"); 11686 if (subtype_info == NULL) 11687 { 11688 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type); 11689 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type); 11690 11691 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX) 11692 return raw_type; 11693 else 11694 return create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type, 11695 L, U); 11696 } 11697 else 11698 { 11699 static char *name_buf = NULL; 11700 static size_t name_len = 0; 11701 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name; 11702 LONGEST L, U; 11703 struct type *type; 11704 const char *bounds_str; 11705 int n; 11706 11707 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5); 11708 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len); 11709 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0'; 11710 11711 subtype_info += 5; 11712 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_'); 11713 n = 1; 11714 11715 if (*subtype_info == 'L') 11716 { 11717 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n) 11718 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n)) 11719 return raw_type; 11720 if (bounds_str[n] == '_') 11721 n += 2; 11722 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */ 11723 n += 1; 11724 subtype_info += 1; 11725 } 11726 else 11727 { 11728 int ok; 11729 11730 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L"); 11731 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok); 11732 if (!ok) 11733 { 11734 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1.")); 11735 L = 1; 11736 } 11737 } 11738 11739 if (*subtype_info == 'U') 11740 { 11741 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n) 11742 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n)) 11743 return raw_type; 11744 } 11745 else 11746 { 11747 int ok; 11748 11749 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U"); 11750 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok); 11751 if (!ok) 11752 { 11753 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L); 11754 U = L; 11755 } 11756 } 11757 11758 type = create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), 11759 base_type, L, U); 11760 TYPE_NAME (type) = name; 11761 return type; 11762 } 11763 } 11764 11765 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */ 11766 11767 int 11768 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name) 11769 { 11770 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD")); 11771 } 11772 11773 11774 /* Modular types */ 11775 11776 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */ 11777 11778 int 11779 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type) 11780 { 11781 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type); 11782 11783 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE 11784 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT 11785 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type)); 11786 } 11787 11788 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */ 11789 11790 ULONGEST 11791 ada_modulus (struct type *type) 11792 { 11793 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1; 11794 } 11795 11796 11797 /* Ada exception catchpoint support: 11798 --------------------------------- 11799 11800 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints: 11801 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions 11802 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions 11803 . catchpoints on failed assertions 11804 11805 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions 11806 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions. 11807 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having 11808 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful 11809 to zero-in on certain situations. 11810 11811 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint, 11812 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines 11813 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard 11814 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set 11815 of breakpoint_ops. 11816 11817 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed 11818 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation 11819 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several 11820 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine 11821 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */ 11822 11823 /* Ada's standard exceptions. 11824 11825 The Ada 83 standard also defined Numeric_Error. But there so many 11826 situations where it was unclear from the Ada 83 Reference Manual 11827 (RM) whether Constraint_Error or Numeric_Error should be raised, 11828 that the ARG (Ada Rapporteur Group) eventually issued a Binding 11829 Interpretation saying that anytime the RM says that Numeric_Error 11830 should be raised, the implementation may raise Constraint_Error. 11831 Ada 95 went one step further and pretty much removed Numeric_Error 11832 from the list of standard exceptions (it made it a renaming of 11833 Constraint_Error, to help preserve compatibility when compiling 11834 an Ada83 compiler). As such, we do not include Numeric_Error from 11835 this list of standard exceptions. */ 11836 11837 static const char *standard_exc[] = { 11838 "constraint_error", 11839 "program_error", 11840 "storage_error", 11841 "tasking_error" 11842 }; 11843 11844 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void); 11845 11846 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints 11847 for a given executable. */ 11848 11849 struct exception_support_info 11850 { 11851 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert 11852 a catchpoint on exceptions. */ 11853 const char *catch_exception_sym; 11854 11855 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert 11856 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */ 11857 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym; 11858 11859 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert 11860 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */ 11861 const char *catch_assert_sym; 11862 11863 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception 11864 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address 11865 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored. 11866 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */ 11867 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr; 11868 }; 11869 11870 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void); 11871 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void); 11872 11873 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to 11874 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the 11875 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */ 11876 11877 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info = 11878 { 11879 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */ 11880 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */ 11881 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */ 11882 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr 11883 }; 11884 11885 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to 11886 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version 11887 of the Ada runtime. */ 11888 11889 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback = 11890 { 11891 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */ 11892 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */ 11893 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */ 11894 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise 11895 }; 11896 11897 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines 11898 described in EINFO. 11899 11900 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected 11901 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but 11902 that support is found to be incomplete). */ 11903 11904 static int 11905 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo) 11906 { 11907 struct symbol *sym; 11908 11909 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime 11910 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we 11911 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */ 11912 11913 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN); 11914 if (sym == NULL) 11915 { 11916 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was 11917 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it. 11918 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where 11919 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get 11920 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user 11921 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint. 11922 11923 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception 11924 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol. 11925 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are 11926 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract 11927 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in 11928 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch 11929 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */ 11930 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym 11931 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL); 11932 11933 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline) 11934 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging " 11935 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint " 11936 "in this configuration.")); 11937 11938 return 0; 11939 } 11940 11941 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */ 11942 11943 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK) 11944 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"), 11945 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym)); 11946 11947 return 1; 11948 } 11949 11950 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure 11951 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints. 11952 11953 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info, 11954 or raise an error. */ 11955 11956 static void 11957 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void) 11958 { 11959 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ()); 11960 11961 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */ 11962 if (data->exception_info != NULL) 11963 return; 11964 11965 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */ 11966 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info)) 11967 { 11968 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info; 11969 return; 11970 } 11971 11972 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */ 11973 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback)) 11974 { 11975 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback; 11976 return; 11977 } 11978 11979 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine 11980 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with 11981 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been 11982 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if 11983 applicable. */ 11984 11985 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada) 11986 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?")); 11987 11988 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is 11989 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been 11990 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is 11991 in a shared library. */ 11992 11993 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0) 11994 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first.")); 11995 11996 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and 11997 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to 11998 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in 11999 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized 12000 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth 12001 supporting this feature. */ 12002 12003 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration.")); 12004 } 12005 12006 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is 12007 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is 12008 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting 12009 to most users. */ 12010 12011 static int 12012 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame) 12013 { 12014 struct symtab_and_line sal; 12015 char *func_name; 12016 enum language func_lang; 12017 int i; 12018 const char *fullname; 12019 12020 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab), 12021 This cannot be any user code. */ 12022 12023 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal); 12024 if (sal.symtab == NULL) 12025 return 1; 12026 12027 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be 12028 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame 12029 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful 12030 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks 12031 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */ 12032 12033 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab); 12034 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0) 12035 return 1; 12036 12037 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming. 12038 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some 12039 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info 12040 too. */ 12041 12042 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1) 12043 { 12044 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]); 12045 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename))) 12046 return 1; 12047 if (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab) != NULL 12048 && re_exec (objfile_name (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab)))) 12049 return 1; 12050 } 12051 12052 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */ 12053 12054 find_frame_funname (frame, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL); 12055 if (func_name == NULL) 12056 return 1; 12057 12058 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1) 12059 { 12060 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]); 12061 if (re_exec (func_name)) 12062 { 12063 xfree (func_name); 12064 return 1; 12065 } 12066 } 12067 12068 xfree (func_name); 12069 return 0; 12070 } 12071 12072 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not 12073 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */ 12074 12075 void 12076 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi) 12077 { 12078 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi)) 12079 { 12080 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi)) 12081 { 12082 select_frame (fi); 12083 break; 12084 } 12085 } 12086 12087 } 12088 12089 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception 12090 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name 12091 of the exception is stored. 12092 12093 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */ 12094 12095 static CORE_ADDR 12096 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void) 12097 { 12098 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"); 12099 } 12100 12101 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function 12102 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime, 12103 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame 12104 several frames up in the callstack. */ 12105 12106 static CORE_ADDR 12107 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void) 12108 { 12109 int frame_level; 12110 struct frame_info *fi; 12111 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ()); 12112 struct cleanup *old_chain; 12113 12114 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select 12115 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is 12116 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames 12117 without checking the name of their associated function. */ 12118 fi = get_current_frame (); 12119 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1) 12120 if (fi != NULL) 12121 fi = get_prev_frame (fi); 12122 12123 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); 12124 while (fi != NULL) 12125 { 12126 char *func_name; 12127 enum language func_lang; 12128 12129 find_frame_funname (fi, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL); 12130 if (func_name != NULL) 12131 { 12132 make_cleanup (xfree, func_name); 12133 12134 if (strcmp (func_name, 12135 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0) 12136 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */ 12137 fi = get_prev_frame (fi); 12138 } 12139 } 12140 do_cleanups (old_chain); 12141 12142 if (fi == NULL) 12143 return 0; 12144 12145 select_frame (fi); 12146 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name"); 12147 } 12148 12149 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint 12150 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name 12151 of the exception is stored, if applicable. 12152 12153 Assumes the selected frame is the current frame. 12154 12155 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */ 12156 12157 static CORE_ADDR 12158 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12159 struct breakpoint *b) 12160 { 12161 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ()); 12162 12163 switch (ex) 12164 { 12165 case ada_catch_exception: 12166 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name")); 12167 break; 12168 12169 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12170 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr (); 12171 break; 12172 12173 case ada_catch_assert: 12174 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */ 12175 break; 12176 12177 default: 12178 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type")); 12179 break; 12180 } 12181 12182 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */ 12183 } 12184 12185 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains 12186 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown. 12187 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed, 12188 and zero is returned. */ 12189 12190 static CORE_ADDR 12191 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12192 struct breakpoint *b) 12193 { 12194 CORE_ADDR result = 0; 12195 12196 TRY 12197 { 12198 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b); 12199 } 12200 12201 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) 12202 { 12203 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message); 12204 return 0; 12205 } 12206 END_CATCH 12207 12208 return result; 12209 } 12210 12211 static char *ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string); 12212 12213 /* Ada catchpoints. 12214 12215 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will 12216 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user 12217 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this 12218 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse 12219 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations. 12220 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was 12221 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the 12222 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested 12223 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression 12224 when symbols change. */ 12225 12226 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint 12227 breakpoint location. It includes a "struct bp_location" as a kind 12228 of base class; users downcast to "struct bp_location *" when 12229 needed. */ 12230 12231 struct ada_catchpoint_location 12232 { 12233 /* The base class. */ 12234 struct bp_location base; 12235 12236 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised 12237 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint 12238 creation. */ 12239 expression_up excep_cond_expr; 12240 }; 12241 12242 /* Implement the DTOR method in the bp_location_ops structure for all 12243 Ada exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12244 12245 static void 12246 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor (struct bp_location *bl) 12247 { 12248 struct ada_catchpoint_location *al = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl; 12249 12250 al->excep_cond_expr.reset (); 12251 } 12252 12253 /* The vtable to be used in Ada catchpoint locations. */ 12254 12255 static const struct bp_location_ops ada_catchpoint_location_ops = 12256 { 12257 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor 12258 }; 12259 12260 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint. 12261 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users 12262 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. */ 12263 12264 struct ada_catchpoint 12265 { 12266 /* The base class. */ 12267 struct breakpoint base; 12268 12269 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */ 12270 char *excep_string; 12271 }; 12272 12273 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the 12274 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */ 12275 12276 static void 12277 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c) 12278 { 12279 struct cleanup *old_chain; 12280 struct bp_location *bl; 12281 char *cond_string; 12282 12283 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */ 12284 if (c->excep_string == NULL) 12285 return; 12286 12287 /* Same if there are no locations... */ 12288 if (c->base.loc == NULL) 12289 return; 12290 12291 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific 12292 expection we want to catch. */ 12293 cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string); 12294 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string); 12295 12296 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an 12297 expression for each. */ 12298 for (bl = c->base.loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next) 12299 { 12300 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc 12301 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl; 12302 expression_up exp; 12303 12304 if (!bl->shlib_disabled) 12305 { 12306 const char *s; 12307 12308 s = cond_string; 12309 TRY 12310 { 12311 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address, 12312 block_for_pc (bl->address), 12313 0); 12314 } 12315 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) 12316 { 12317 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition " 12318 "for catchpoint %d: %s"), 12319 c->base.number, e.message); 12320 } 12321 END_CATCH 12322 } 12323 12324 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = std::move (exp); 12325 } 12326 12327 do_cleanups (old_chain); 12328 } 12329 12330 /* Implement the DTOR method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all 12331 exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12332 12333 static void 12334 dtor_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b) 12335 { 12336 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b; 12337 12338 xfree (c->excep_string); 12339 12340 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b); 12341 } 12342 12343 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops 12344 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12345 12346 static struct bp_location * 12347 allocate_location_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12348 struct breakpoint *self) 12349 { 12350 struct ada_catchpoint_location *loc; 12351 12352 loc = new ada_catchpoint_location (); 12353 init_bp_location (&loc->base, &ada_catchpoint_location_ops, self); 12354 loc->excep_cond_expr = NULL; 12355 return &loc->base; 12356 } 12357 12358 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all 12359 exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12360 12361 static void 12362 re_set_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b) 12363 { 12364 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b; 12365 12366 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's 12367 locations. */ 12368 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b); 12369 12370 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each 12371 location. */ 12372 create_excep_cond_exprs (c); 12373 } 12374 12375 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the 12376 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop 12377 if the program thrown that exception. */ 12378 12379 static int 12380 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl) 12381 { 12382 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner; 12383 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc 12384 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl; 12385 int stop; 12386 12387 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */ 12388 if (c->excep_string == NULL) 12389 return 1; 12390 12391 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL) 12392 { 12393 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating 12394 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */ 12395 return 1; 12396 } 12397 12398 stop = 1; 12399 TRY 12400 { 12401 struct value *mark; 12402 12403 mark = value_mark (); 12404 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr.get ())); 12405 value_free_to_mark (mark); 12406 } 12407 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL) 12408 { 12409 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, 12410 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n")); 12411 } 12412 END_CATCH 12413 12414 return stop; 12415 } 12416 12417 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure 12418 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12419 12420 static void 12421 check_status_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs) 12422 { 12423 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at); 12424 } 12425 12426 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure 12427 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12428 12429 static enum print_stop_action 12430 print_it_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs) 12431 { 12432 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; 12433 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; 12434 12435 annotate_catchpoint (b->number); 12436 12437 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) 12438 { 12439 uiout->field_string ("reason", 12440 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); 12441 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); 12442 } 12443 12444 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del 12445 ? "\nTemporary catchpoint " : "\nCatchpoint "); 12446 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); 12447 uiout->text (", "); 12448 12449 /* ada_exception_name_addr relies on the selected frame being the 12450 current frame. Need to do this here because this function may be 12451 called more than once when printing a stop, and below, we'll 12452 select the first frame past the Ada run-time (see 12453 ada_find_printable_frame). */ 12454 select_frame (get_current_frame ()); 12455 12456 switch (ex) 12457 { 12458 case ada_catch_exception: 12459 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12460 { 12461 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b); 12462 char exception_name[256]; 12463 12464 if (addr != 0) 12465 { 12466 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name, 12467 sizeof (exception_name) - 1); 12468 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0'; 12469 } 12470 else 12471 { 12472 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception 12473 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled 12474 without debugging info, for instance. In that case, 12475 just replace the exception name by the generic string 12476 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the 12477 notification we are about to print. */ 12478 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception")); 12479 } 12480 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print 12481 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make 12482 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got 12483 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra 12484 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */ 12485 if (ex == ada_catch_exception_unhandled) 12486 uiout->text ("unhandled "); 12487 uiout->field_string ("exception-name", exception_name); 12488 } 12489 break; 12490 case ada_catch_assert: 12491 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really 12492 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer 12493 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint. 12494 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in 12495 the MI output. */ 12496 uiout->text ("failed assertion"); 12497 break; 12498 } 12499 uiout->text (" at "); 12500 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ()); 12501 12502 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; 12503 } 12504 12505 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure 12506 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12507 12508 static void 12509 print_one_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12510 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) 12511 { 12512 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; 12513 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b; 12514 struct value_print_options opts; 12515 12516 get_user_print_options (&opts); 12517 if (opts.addressprint) 12518 { 12519 annotate_field (4); 12520 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address); 12521 } 12522 12523 annotate_field (5); 12524 *last_loc = b->loc; 12525 switch (ex) 12526 { 12527 case ada_catch_exception: 12528 if (c->excep_string != NULL) 12529 { 12530 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string); 12531 12532 uiout->field_string ("what", msg); 12533 xfree (msg); 12534 } 12535 else 12536 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions"); 12537 12538 break; 12539 12540 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12541 uiout->field_string ("what", "unhandled Ada exceptions"); 12542 break; 12543 12544 case ada_catch_assert: 12545 uiout->field_string ("what", "failed Ada assertions"); 12546 break; 12547 12548 default: 12549 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type")); 12550 break; 12551 } 12552 } 12553 12554 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure 12555 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12556 12557 static void 12558 print_mention_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12559 struct breakpoint *b) 12560 { 12561 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b; 12562 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; 12563 12564 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ") 12565 : _("Catchpoint ")); 12566 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); 12567 uiout->text (": "); 12568 12569 switch (ex) 12570 { 12571 case ada_catch_exception: 12572 if (c->excep_string != NULL) 12573 { 12574 char *info = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string); 12575 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, info); 12576 12577 uiout->text (info); 12578 do_cleanups (old_chain); 12579 } 12580 else 12581 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions")); 12582 break; 12583 12584 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12585 uiout->text (_("unhandled Ada exceptions")); 12586 break; 12587 12588 case ada_catch_assert: 12589 uiout->text (_("failed Ada assertions")); 12590 break; 12591 12592 default: 12593 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type")); 12594 break; 12595 } 12596 } 12597 12598 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure 12599 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */ 12600 12601 static void 12602 print_recreate_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, 12603 struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) 12604 { 12605 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b; 12606 12607 switch (ex) 12608 { 12609 case ada_catch_exception: 12610 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception"); 12611 if (c->excep_string != NULL) 12612 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string); 12613 break; 12614 12615 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12616 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled"); 12617 break; 12618 12619 case ada_catch_assert: 12620 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert"); 12621 break; 12622 12623 default: 12624 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type")); 12625 } 12626 print_recreate_thread (b, fp); 12627 } 12628 12629 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */ 12630 12631 static void 12632 dtor_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b) 12633 { 12634 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception, b); 12635 } 12636 12637 static struct bp_location * 12638 allocate_location_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *self) 12639 { 12640 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception, self); 12641 } 12642 12643 static void 12644 re_set_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b) 12645 { 12646 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception, b); 12647 } 12648 12649 static void 12650 check_status_catch_exception (bpstat bs) 12651 { 12652 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs); 12653 } 12654 12655 static enum print_stop_action 12656 print_it_catch_exception (bpstat bs) 12657 { 12658 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs); 12659 } 12660 12661 static void 12662 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) 12663 { 12664 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, last_loc); 12665 } 12666 12667 static void 12668 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b) 12669 { 12670 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception, b); 12671 } 12672 12673 static void 12674 print_recreate_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) 12675 { 12676 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, fp); 12677 } 12678 12679 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops; 12680 12681 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */ 12682 12683 static void 12684 dtor_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b) 12685 { 12686 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b); 12687 } 12688 12689 static struct bp_location * 12690 allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *self) 12691 { 12692 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, self); 12693 } 12694 12695 static void 12696 re_set_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b) 12697 { 12698 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b); 12699 } 12700 12701 static void 12702 check_status_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs) 12703 { 12704 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs); 12705 } 12706 12707 static enum print_stop_action 12708 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs) 12709 { 12710 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs); 12711 } 12712 12713 static void 12714 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b, 12715 struct bp_location **last_loc) 12716 { 12717 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc); 12718 } 12719 12720 static void 12721 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b) 12722 { 12723 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b); 12724 } 12725 12726 static void 12727 print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b, 12728 struct ui_file *fp) 12729 { 12730 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, fp); 12731 } 12732 12733 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops; 12734 12735 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */ 12736 12737 static void 12738 dtor_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b) 12739 { 12740 dtor_exception (ada_catch_assert, b); 12741 } 12742 12743 static struct bp_location * 12744 allocate_location_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *self) 12745 { 12746 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_assert, self); 12747 } 12748 12749 static void 12750 re_set_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b) 12751 { 12752 re_set_exception (ada_catch_assert, b); 12753 } 12754 12755 static void 12756 check_status_catch_assert (bpstat bs) 12757 { 12758 check_status_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs); 12759 } 12760 12761 static enum print_stop_action 12762 print_it_catch_assert (bpstat bs) 12763 { 12764 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs); 12765 } 12766 12767 static void 12768 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) 12769 { 12770 print_one_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, last_loc); 12771 } 12772 12773 static void 12774 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b) 12775 { 12776 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_assert, b); 12777 } 12778 12779 static void 12780 print_recreate_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) 12781 { 12782 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, fp); 12783 } 12784 12785 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops; 12786 12787 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token 12788 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that 12789 token. 12790 12791 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */ 12792 12793 static char * 12794 ada_get_next_arg (const char **argsp) 12795 { 12796 const char *args = *argsp; 12797 const char *end; 12798 char *result; 12799 12800 args = skip_spaces_const (args); 12801 if (args[0] == '\0') 12802 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */ 12803 12804 /* Find the end of the current argument. */ 12805 12806 end = skip_to_space_const (args); 12807 12808 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */ 12809 12810 *argsp = end; 12811 12812 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */ 12813 12814 result = (char *) xmalloc (end - args + 1); 12815 strncpy (result, args, end - args); 12816 result[end - args] = '\0'; 12817 12818 return result; 12819 } 12820 12821 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command. 12822 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type. 12823 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if 12824 specified by the user. 12825 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition 12826 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated 12827 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */ 12828 12829 static void 12830 catch_ada_exception_command_split (const char *args, 12831 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex, 12832 char **excep_string, 12833 char **cond_string) 12834 { 12835 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); 12836 char *exception_name; 12837 char *cond = NULL; 12838 12839 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args); 12840 if (exception_name != NULL && strcmp (exception_name, "if") == 0) 12841 { 12842 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition 12843 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get" 12844 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */ 12845 xfree (exception_name); 12846 exception_name = NULL; 12847 args -= 2; 12848 } 12849 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name); 12850 12851 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */ 12852 12853 args = skip_spaces_const (args); 12854 if (startswith (args, "if") 12855 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0')) 12856 { 12857 args += 2; 12858 args = skip_spaces_const (args); 12859 12860 if (args[0] == '\0') 12861 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword")); 12862 cond = xstrdup (args); 12863 make_cleanup (xfree, cond); 12864 12865 args += strlen (args); 12866 } 12867 12868 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else 12869 is unexpected. */ 12870 12871 if (args[0] != '\0') 12872 error (_("Junk at end of expression")); 12873 12874 discard_cleanups (old_chain); 12875 12876 if (exception_name == NULL) 12877 { 12878 /* Catch all exceptions. */ 12879 *ex = ada_catch_exception; 12880 *excep_string = NULL; 12881 } 12882 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0) 12883 { 12884 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */ 12885 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled; 12886 *excep_string = NULL; 12887 } 12888 else 12889 { 12890 /* Catch a specific exception. */ 12891 *ex = ada_catch_exception; 12892 *excep_string = exception_name; 12893 } 12894 *cond_string = cond; 12895 } 12896 12897 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to 12898 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */ 12899 12900 static const char * 12901 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex) 12902 { 12903 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ()); 12904 12905 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL); 12906 12907 switch (ex) 12908 { 12909 case ada_catch_exception: 12910 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym); 12911 break; 12912 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12913 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym); 12914 break; 12915 case ada_catch_assert: 12916 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym); 12917 break; 12918 default: 12919 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, 12920 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex); 12921 } 12922 } 12923 12924 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints 12925 of the EX kind. */ 12926 12927 static const struct breakpoint_ops * 12928 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex) 12929 { 12930 switch (ex) 12931 { 12932 case ada_catch_exception: 12933 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops); 12934 break; 12935 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled: 12936 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops); 12937 break; 12938 case ada_catch_assert: 12939 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops); 12940 break; 12941 default: 12942 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, 12943 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex); 12944 } 12945 } 12946 12947 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception 12948 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This 12949 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered 12950 an exception catchpoint. 12951 12952 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be 12953 deallocated later. */ 12954 12955 static char * 12956 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string) 12957 { 12958 int i; 12959 12960 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in 12961 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if 12962 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard 12963 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation 12964 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would 12965 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition 12966 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the 12967 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error). 12968 12969 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are 12970 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch 12971 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception 12972 standard.constraint_error". 12973 12974 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of 12975 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a 12976 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named: 12977 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */ 12978 12979 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++) 12980 { 12981 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0) 12982 { 12983 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)", 12984 excep_string); 12985 } 12986 } 12987 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", excep_string); 12988 } 12989 12990 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception 12991 catchpoint of the TYPE kind. 12992 12993 EXCEP_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception that 12994 the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise. 12995 12996 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real 12997 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the 12998 type of catchpoint we need to create. */ 12999 13000 static struct symtab_and_line 13001 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *excep_string, 13002 char **addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops) 13003 { 13004 const char *sym_name; 13005 struct symbol *sym; 13006 13007 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */ 13008 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (); 13009 13010 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch 13011 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */ 13012 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex); 13013 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN); 13014 13015 /* We can assume that SYM is not NULL at this stage. If the symbol 13016 did not exist, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer would have 13017 raised an exception. 13018 13019 Also, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer should have already 13020 verified that SYM is a function symbol. */ 13021 gdb_assert (sym != NULL); 13022 gdb_assert (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_BLOCK); 13023 13024 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */ 13025 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name); 13026 13027 /* Set OPS. */ 13028 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex); 13029 13030 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1); 13031 } 13032 13033 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint. 13034 13035 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created. 13036 13037 If EXCEPT_STRING is NULL, this catchpoint is expected to trigger 13038 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name 13039 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies. When not NULL, 13040 the string must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation 13041 is no longer the responsibility of the caller. 13042 13043 COND_STRING, if not NULL, is the catchpoint condition. This string 13044 must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation is no longer 13045 the responsibility of the caller. 13046 13047 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint 13048 should be temporary. 13049 13050 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */ 13051 13052 void 13053 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, 13054 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind, 13055 char *excep_string, 13056 char *cond_string, 13057 int tempflag, 13058 int disabled, 13059 int from_tty) 13060 { 13061 struct ada_catchpoint *c; 13062 char *addr_string = NULL; 13063 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL; 13064 struct symtab_and_line sal 13065 = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, excep_string, &addr_string, &ops); 13066 13067 c = new ada_catchpoint (); 13068 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, sal, addr_string, 13069 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty); 13070 c->excep_string = excep_string; 13071 create_excep_cond_exprs (c); 13072 if (cond_string != NULL) 13073 set_breakpoint_condition (&c->base, cond_string, from_tty); 13074 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1); 13075 } 13076 13077 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */ 13078 13079 static void 13080 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg_entry, int from_tty, 13081 struct cmd_list_element *command) 13082 { 13083 const char *arg = arg_entry; 13084 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); 13085 int tempflag; 13086 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind; 13087 char *excep_string = NULL; 13088 char *cond_string = NULL; 13089 13090 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY; 13091 13092 if (!arg) 13093 arg = ""; 13094 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, &ex_kind, &excep_string, 13095 &cond_string); 13096 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind, 13097 excep_string, cond_string, 13098 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */, 13099 from_tty); 13100 } 13101 13102 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command. 13103 13104 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if 13105 no arguments were passed). 13106 13107 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition 13108 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */ 13109 13110 static void 13111 catch_ada_assert_command_split (const char *args, char **cond_string) 13112 { 13113 args = skip_spaces_const (args); 13114 13115 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */ 13116 if (startswith (args, "if") 13117 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0')) 13118 { 13119 args += 2; 13120 args = skip_spaces_const (args); 13121 if (args[0] == '\0') 13122 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword")); 13123 *cond_string = xstrdup (args); 13124 } 13125 13126 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of 13127 the command. */ 13128 else if (args[0] != '\0') 13129 error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); 13130 } 13131 13132 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */ 13133 13134 static void 13135 catch_assert_command (char *arg_entry, int from_tty, 13136 struct cmd_list_element *command) 13137 { 13138 const char *arg = arg_entry; 13139 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); 13140 int tempflag; 13141 char *cond_string = NULL; 13142 13143 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY; 13144 13145 if (!arg) 13146 arg = ""; 13147 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, &cond_string); 13148 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert, 13149 NULL, cond_string, 13150 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */, 13151 from_tty); 13152 } 13153 13154 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */ 13155 13156 static int 13157 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym) 13158 { 13159 const char *type_name = type_name_no_tag (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym)); 13160 13161 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF 13162 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK 13163 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST 13164 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED 13165 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0); 13166 } 13167 13168 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard 13169 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones 13170 defined by the Ada language. */ 13171 13172 static int 13173 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym) 13174 { 13175 int i; 13176 13177 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym)) 13178 return 0; 13179 13180 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++) 13181 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), standard_exc[i]) == 0) 13182 return 0; /* A standard exception. */ 13183 13184 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it. 13185 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why 13186 this exception is not listed in that array. */ 13187 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "numeric_error") == 0) 13188 return 0; 13189 13190 return 1; 13191 } 13192 13193 /* A helper function for qsort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info 13194 objects. 13195 13196 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then 13197 by exception address. */ 13198 13199 static int 13200 compare_ada_exception_info (const void *a, const void *b) 13201 { 13202 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_a = (struct ada_exc_info *) a; 13203 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_b = (struct ada_exc_info *) b; 13204 int result; 13205 13206 result = strcmp (exc_a->name, exc_b->name); 13207 if (result != 0) 13208 return result; 13209 13210 if (exc_a->addr < exc_b->addr) 13211 return -1; 13212 if (exc_a->addr > exc_b->addr) 13213 return 1; 13214 13215 return 0; 13216 } 13217 13218 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison 13219 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched. 13220 13221 All duplicates are also removed. */ 13222 13223 static void 13224 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions, 13225 int skip) 13226 { 13227 struct ada_exc_info *to_sort 13228 = VEC_address (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) + skip; 13229 int to_sort_len 13230 = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) - skip; 13231 int i, j; 13232 13233 qsort (to_sort, to_sort_len, sizeof (struct ada_exc_info), 13234 compare_ada_exception_info); 13235 13236 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < to_sort_len; i++) 13237 if (compare_ada_exception_info (&to_sort[i], &to_sort[j - 1]) != 0) 13238 to_sort[j++] = to_sort[i]; 13239 to_sort_len = j; 13240 VEC_truncate(ada_exc_info, *exceptions, skip + to_sort_len); 13241 } 13242 13243 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match 13244 a regular expression. 13245 13246 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to 13247 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based 13248 filtering is performed. 13249 13250 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions 13251 gets pushed. */ 13252 13253 static void 13254 ada_add_standard_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions) 13255 { 13256 int i; 13257 13258 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++) 13259 { 13260 if (preg == NULL 13261 || regexec (preg, standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0) 13262 { 13263 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol 13264 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]); 13265 13266 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL) 13267 { 13268 struct ada_exc_info info 13269 = {standard_exc[i], BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol)}; 13270 13271 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info); 13272 } 13273 } 13274 } 13275 } 13276 13277 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given 13278 FRAME. 13279 13280 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to 13281 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based 13282 filtering is performed. 13283 13284 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions 13285 gets pushed. */ 13286 13287 static void 13288 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (regex_t *preg, struct frame_info *frame, 13289 VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions) 13290 { 13291 const struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0); 13292 13293 while (block != 0) 13294 { 13295 struct block_iterator iter; 13296 struct symbol *sym; 13297 13298 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym) 13299 { 13300 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym)) 13301 { 13302 case LOC_TYPEDEF: 13303 case LOC_BLOCK: 13304 case LOC_CONST: 13305 break; 13306 default: 13307 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym)) 13308 { 13309 struct ada_exc_info info = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym), 13310 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)}; 13311 13312 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info); 13313 } 13314 } 13315 } 13316 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL) 13317 break; 13318 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block); 13319 } 13320 } 13321 13322 /* Return true if NAME matches PREG or if PREG is NULL. */ 13323 13324 static bool 13325 name_matches_regex (const char *name, regex_t *preg) 13326 { 13327 return (preg == NULL 13328 || regexec (preg, ada_decode (name), 0, NULL, 0) == 0); 13329 } 13330 13331 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match 13332 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions. 13333 13334 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need 13335 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside 13336 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info, 13337 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However, 13338 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to 13339 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found 13340 during the special loop that specifically searches for those 13341 standard exceptions. 13342 13343 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to 13344 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based 13345 filtering is performed. 13346 13347 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions 13348 gets pushed. */ 13349 13350 static void 13351 ada_add_global_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions) 13352 { 13353 struct objfile *objfile; 13354 struct compunit_symtab *s; 13355 13356 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas the 13357 regular expression used to do the matching refers to the natural 13358 name. So match against the decoded name. */ 13359 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, 13360 [&] (const char *search_name) 13361 { 13362 const char *decoded = ada_decode (search_name); 13363 return name_matches_regex (decoded, preg); 13364 }, 13365 NULL, 13366 VARIABLES_DOMAIN); 13367 13368 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s) 13369 { 13370 const struct blockvector *bv = COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s); 13371 int i; 13372 13373 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++) 13374 { 13375 struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i); 13376 struct block_iterator iter; 13377 struct symbol *sym; 13378 13379 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym) 13380 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym) 13381 && name_matches_regex (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (sym), preg)) 13382 { 13383 struct ada_exc_info info 13384 = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)}; 13385 13386 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info); 13387 } 13388 } 13389 } 13390 } 13391 13392 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed 13393 as a regex_t, rather than a string. 13394 13395 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names 13396 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */ 13397 13398 static VEC(ada_exc_info) * 13399 ada_exceptions_list_1 (regex_t *preg) 13400 { 13401 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL; 13402 struct cleanup *old_chain 13403 = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &result); 13404 int prev_len; 13405 13406 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions 13407 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in 13408 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */ 13409 13410 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result); 13411 13412 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible 13413 from the currently selected frame. */ 13414 13415 if (has_stack_frames ()) 13416 { 13417 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result); 13418 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL), 13419 &result); 13420 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len) 13421 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len); 13422 } 13423 13424 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */ 13425 13426 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result); 13427 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result); 13428 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len) 13429 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len); 13430 13431 discard_cleanups (old_chain); 13432 return result; 13433 } 13434 13435 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info. 13436 13437 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result. 13438 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression, 13439 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression 13440 are included in the result. 13441 13442 The exceptions are sorted in the following order: 13443 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in 13444 alphabetical order; 13445 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in 13446 alphabetical order; 13447 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */ 13448 13449 VEC(ada_exc_info) * 13450 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp) 13451 { 13452 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL; 13453 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL; 13454 regex_t reg; 13455 13456 if (regexp != NULL) 13457 old_chain = compile_rx_or_error (®, regexp, 13458 _("invalid regular expression")); 13459 13460 result = ada_exceptions_list_1 (regexp != NULL ? ® : NULL); 13461 13462 if (old_chain != NULL) 13463 do_cleanups (old_chain); 13464 return result; 13465 } 13466 13467 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */ 13468 13469 static void 13470 info_exceptions_command (char *regexp, int from_tty) 13471 { 13472 VEC(ada_exc_info) *exceptions; 13473 struct cleanup *cleanup; 13474 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); 13475 int ix; 13476 struct ada_exc_info *info; 13477 13478 exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp); 13479 cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &exceptions); 13480 13481 if (regexp != NULL) 13482 printf_filtered 13483 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp); 13484 else 13485 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n")); 13486 13487 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(ada_exc_info, exceptions, ix, info); ix++) 13488 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info->name, paddress (gdbarch, info->addr)); 13489 13490 do_cleanups (cleanup); 13491 } 13492 13493 /* Operators */ 13494 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions 13495 below. */ 13496 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */ 13497 13498 #define ADA_OPERATORS \ 13499 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \ 13500 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \ 13501 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \ 13502 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \ 13503 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \ 13504 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \ 13505 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \ 13506 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \ 13507 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \ 13508 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \ 13509 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \ 13510 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \ 13511 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \ 13512 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \ 13513 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \ 13514 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \ 13515 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \ 13516 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \ 13517 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0) 13518 13519 static void 13520 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp, 13521 int *argsp) 13522 { 13523 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode) 13524 { 13525 default: 13526 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp); 13527 break; 13528 13529 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \ 13530 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break; 13531 ADA_OPERATORS; 13532 #undef OP_DEFN 13533 13534 case OP_AGGREGATE: 13535 *oplenp = 3; 13536 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst); 13537 break; 13538 13539 case OP_CHOICES: 13540 *oplenp = 3; 13541 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1; 13542 break; 13543 } 13544 } 13545 13546 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */ 13547 13548 static int 13549 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos, 13550 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data), 13551 void *data) 13552 { 13553 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts; 13554 struct type *type = NULL; 13555 13556 switch (elts[pos].opcode) 13557 { 13558 case UNOP_IN_RANGE: 13559 case UNOP_QUAL: 13560 type = elts[pos + 1].type; 13561 break; 13562 13563 default: 13564 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data); 13565 } 13566 13567 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */ 13568 13569 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type) 13570 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data)) 13571 return 1; 13572 13573 return 0; 13574 } 13575 13576 static const char * 13577 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode) 13578 { 13579 switch (opcode) 13580 { 13581 default: 13582 return op_name_standard (opcode); 13583 13584 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op; 13585 ADA_OPERATORS; 13586 #undef OP_DEFN 13587 13588 case OP_AGGREGATE: 13589 return "OP_AGGREGATE"; 13590 case OP_CHOICES: 13591 return "OP_CHOICES"; 13592 case OP_NAME: 13593 return "OP_NAME"; 13594 } 13595 } 13596 13597 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first 13598 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the 13599 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */ 13600 13601 static void 13602 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc, 13603 int *oplenp, int *argsp) 13604 { 13605 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode) 13606 { 13607 default: 13608 *oplenp = *argsp = 0; 13609 break; 13610 13611 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \ 13612 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break; 13613 ADA_OPERATORS; 13614 #undef OP_DEFN 13615 13616 case OP_AGGREGATE: 13617 *oplenp = 3; 13618 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 13619 break; 13620 13621 case OP_CHOICES: 13622 *oplenp = 3; 13623 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1; 13624 break; 13625 13626 case OP_STRING: 13627 case OP_NAME: 13628 { 13629 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 13630 13631 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1); 13632 *argsp = 0; 13633 break; 13634 } 13635 } 13636 } 13637 13638 static int 13639 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt) 13640 { 13641 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode; 13642 int oplen, nargs; 13643 int pc = elt; 13644 int i; 13645 13646 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs); 13647 13648 switch (op) 13649 { 13650 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */ 13651 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 13652 case OP_ATR_LAST: 13653 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 13654 case OP_ATR_IMAGE: 13655 case OP_ATR_MAX: 13656 case OP_ATR_MIN: 13657 case OP_ATR_MODULUS: 13658 case OP_ATR_POS: 13659 case OP_ATR_SIZE: 13660 case OP_ATR_TAG: 13661 case OP_ATR_VAL: 13662 break; 13663 13664 case UNOP_IN_RANGE: 13665 case UNOP_QUAL: 13666 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */ 13667 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @")); 13668 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream); 13669 fprintf_filtered (stream, " ("); 13670 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0); 13671 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")"); 13672 break; 13673 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS: 13674 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)", 13675 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst)); 13676 break; 13677 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE: 13678 break; 13679 13680 case OP_AGGREGATE: 13681 case OP_OTHERS: 13682 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE: 13683 case OP_POSITIONAL: 13684 case OP_CHOICES: 13685 break; 13686 13687 case OP_NAME: 13688 case OP_STRING: 13689 { 13690 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string; 13691 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst); 13692 13693 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name); 13694 break; 13695 } 13696 13697 default: 13698 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt); 13699 } 13700 13701 elt += oplen; 13702 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1) 13703 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt); 13704 13705 return elt; 13706 } 13707 13708 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */ 13709 13710 static void 13711 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos, 13712 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec) 13713 { 13714 int oplen, nargs, i; 13715 int pc = *pos; 13716 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode; 13717 13718 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs); 13719 13720 *pos += oplen; 13721 switch (op) 13722 { 13723 default: 13724 *pos -= oplen; 13725 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec); 13726 return; 13727 13728 case OP_VAR_VALUE: 13729 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream); 13730 return; 13731 13732 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS: 13733 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */ 13734 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13735 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream); 13736 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13737 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream); 13738 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1) 13739 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)", 13740 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst); 13741 return; 13742 13743 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE: 13744 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL) 13745 fputs_filtered ("(", stream); 13746 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */ 13747 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13748 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream); 13749 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL); 13750 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream); 13751 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL); 13752 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL) 13753 fputs_filtered (")", stream); 13754 return; 13755 13756 case OP_ATR_FIRST: 13757 case OP_ATR_LAST: 13758 case OP_ATR_LENGTH: 13759 case OP_ATR_IMAGE: 13760 case OP_ATR_MAX: 13761 case OP_ATR_MIN: 13762 case OP_ATR_MODULUS: 13763 case OP_ATR_POS: 13764 case OP_ATR_SIZE: 13765 case OP_ATR_TAG: 13766 case OP_ATR_VAL: 13767 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE) 13768 { 13769 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID) 13770 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0, 13771 &type_print_raw_options); 13772 *pos += 3; 13773 } 13774 else 13775 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13776 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op)); 13777 if (nargs > 1) 13778 { 13779 int tem; 13780 13781 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1) 13782 { 13783 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream); 13784 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA); 13785 } 13786 fputs_filtered (")", stream); 13787 } 13788 return; 13789 13790 case UNOP_QUAL: 13791 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0); 13792 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream); 13793 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX); 13794 fputs_filtered (")", stream); 13795 return; 13796 13797 case UNOP_IN_RANGE: 13798 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */ 13799 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13800 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream); 13801 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0, 13802 &type_print_raw_options); 13803 return; 13804 13805 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE: 13806 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13807 fputs_filtered ("..", stream); 13808 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13809 return; 13810 13811 case OP_OTHERS: 13812 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream); 13813 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13814 return; 13815 13816 case OP_CHOICES: 13817 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1) 13818 { 13819 if (i > 0) 13820 fputs_filtered ("|", stream); 13821 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13822 } 13823 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream); 13824 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13825 return; 13826 13827 case OP_POSITIONAL: 13828 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13829 return; 13830 13831 case OP_AGGREGATE: 13832 fputs_filtered ("(", stream); 13833 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1) 13834 { 13835 if (i > 0) 13836 fputs_filtered (", ", stream); 13837 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX); 13838 } 13839 fputs_filtered (")", stream); 13840 return; 13841 } 13842 } 13843 13844 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators 13845 and precedences of the operators. */ 13846 13847 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = { 13848 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1}, 13849 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0}, 13850 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0}, 13851 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0}, 13852 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0}, 13853 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0}, 13854 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0}, 13855 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0}, 13856 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0}, 13857 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0}, 13858 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0}, 13859 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0}, 13860 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0}, 13861 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0}, 13862 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0}, 13863 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0}, 13864 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0}, 13865 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0}, 13866 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0}, 13867 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0}, 13868 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0}, 13869 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0}, 13870 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0}, 13871 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0}, 13872 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0}, 13873 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0}, 13874 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0}, 13875 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0}, 13876 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1}, 13877 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1}, 13878 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1}, 13879 {NULL, OP_NULL, PREC_SUFFIX, 0} 13880 }; 13881 13882 enum ada_primitive_types { 13883 ada_primitive_type_int, 13884 ada_primitive_type_long, 13885 ada_primitive_type_short, 13886 ada_primitive_type_char, 13887 ada_primitive_type_float, 13888 ada_primitive_type_double, 13889 ada_primitive_type_void, 13890 ada_primitive_type_long_long, 13891 ada_primitive_type_long_double, 13892 ada_primitive_type_natural, 13893 ada_primitive_type_positive, 13894 ada_primitive_type_system_address, 13895 nr_ada_primitive_types 13896 }; 13897 13898 static void 13899 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, 13900 struct language_arch_info *lai) 13901 { 13902 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch); 13903 13904 lai->primitive_type_vector 13905 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1, 13906 struct type *); 13907 13908 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int] 13909 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch), 13910 0, "integer"); 13911 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long] 13912 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch), 13913 0, "long_integer"); 13914 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short] 13915 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch), 13916 0, "short_integer"); 13917 lai->string_char_type 13918 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char] 13919 = arch_character_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character"); 13920 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float] 13921 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch), 13922 "float", gdbarch_float_format (gdbarch)); 13923 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double] 13924 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch), 13925 "long_float", gdbarch_double_format (gdbarch)); 13926 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long] 13927 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch), 13928 0, "long_long_integer"); 13929 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double] 13930 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_double_bit (gdbarch), 13931 "long_long_float", gdbarch_long_double_format (gdbarch)); 13932 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural] 13933 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch), 13934 0, "natural"); 13935 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive] 13936 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch), 13937 0, "positive"); 13938 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void] 13939 = builtin->builtin_void; 13940 13941 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address] 13942 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void")); 13943 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]) 13944 = "system__address"; 13945 13946 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL; 13947 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool; 13948 } 13949 13950 /* Language vector */ 13951 13952 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */ 13953 13954 static void 13955 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter) 13956 { 13957 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1); 13958 } 13959 13960 static int 13961 parse (struct parser_state *ps) 13962 { 13963 warnings_issued = 0; 13964 return ada_parse (ps); 13965 } 13966 13967 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = { 13968 ada_print_subexp, 13969 ada_operator_length, 13970 ada_operator_check, 13971 ada_op_name, 13972 ada_dump_subexp_body, 13973 ada_evaluate_subexp 13974 }; 13975 13976 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_cmp" language_defn method 13977 for Ada. */ 13978 13979 static symbol_name_cmp_ftype 13980 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp (const char *lookup_name) 13981 { 13982 if (should_use_wild_match (lookup_name)) 13983 return wild_match; 13984 else 13985 return compare_names; 13986 } 13987 13988 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */ 13989 13990 static struct value * 13991 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, const struct block *var_block, 13992 struct frame_info *frame) 13993 { 13994 const struct block *frame_block = NULL; 13995 struct symbol *renaming_sym = NULL; 13996 13997 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient 13998 is when VAR is a renaming... */ 13999 if (frame) 14000 frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL); 14001 if (frame_block) 14002 renaming_sym = ada_find_renaming_symbol (var, frame_block); 14003 if (renaming_sym != NULL) 14004 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (renaming_sym, frame_block); 14005 14006 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value 14007 function to work. */ 14008 return default_read_var_value (var, var_block, frame); 14009 } 14010 14011 static const char *ada_extensions[] = 14012 { 14013 ".adb", ".ads", ".a", ".ada", ".dg", NULL 14014 }; 14015 14016 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = { 14017 "ada", /* Language name */ 14018 "Ada", 14019 language_ada, 14020 range_check_off, 14021 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but 14022 that's not quite what this means. */ 14023 array_row_major, 14024 macro_expansion_no, 14025 ada_extensions, 14026 &ada_exp_descriptor, 14027 parse, 14028 ada_yyerror, 14029 resolve, 14030 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */ 14031 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */ 14032 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */ 14033 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */ 14034 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */ 14035 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */ 14036 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */ 14037 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */ 14038 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */ 14039 NULL, /* name_of_this */ 14040 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */ 14041 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */ 14042 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */ 14043 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name, 14044 NULL, /* Language specific 14045 class_name_from_physname */ 14046 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */ 14047 0, /* c-style arrays */ 14048 1, /* String lower bound */ 14049 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters, 14050 ada_make_symbol_completion_list, 14051 ada_language_arch_info, 14052 ada_print_array_index, 14053 default_pass_by_reference, 14054 c_get_string, 14055 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp, /* la_get_symbol_name_cmp */ 14056 ada_iterate_over_symbols, 14057 &ada_varobj_ops, 14058 NULL, 14059 NULL, 14060 LANG_MAGIC 14061 }; 14062 14063 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */ 14064 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language; 14065 14066 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */ 14067 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list; 14068 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list; 14069 14070 /* Implement the "set ada" prefix command. */ 14071 14072 static void 14073 set_ada_command (char *arg, int from_tty) 14074 { 14075 printf_unfiltered (_(\ 14076 "\"set ada\" must be followed by the name of a setting.\n")); 14077 help_list (set_ada_list, "set ada ", all_commands, gdb_stdout); 14078 } 14079 14080 /* Implement the "show ada" prefix command. */ 14081 14082 static void 14083 show_ada_command (char *args, int from_tty) 14084 { 14085 cmd_show_list (show_ada_list, from_tty, ""); 14086 } 14087 14088 static void 14089 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void) 14090 { 14091 struct breakpoint_ops *ops; 14092 14093 initialize_breakpoint_ops (); 14094 14095 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops; 14096 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops; 14097 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception; 14098 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception; 14099 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception; 14100 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception; 14101 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception; 14102 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception; 14103 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception; 14104 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception; 14105 14106 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops; 14107 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops; 14108 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception_unhandled; 14109 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled; 14110 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception_unhandled; 14111 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception_unhandled; 14112 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception_unhandled; 14113 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception_unhandled; 14114 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled; 14115 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled; 14116 14117 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops; 14118 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops; 14119 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_assert; 14120 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_assert; 14121 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_assert; 14122 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_assert; 14123 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_assert; 14124 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_assert; 14125 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_assert; 14126 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_assert; 14127 } 14128 14129 /* This module's 'new_objfile' observer. */ 14130 14131 static void 14132 ada_new_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile) 14133 { 14134 ada_clear_symbol_cache (); 14135 } 14136 14137 /* This module's 'free_objfile' observer. */ 14138 14139 static void 14140 ada_free_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile) 14141 { 14142 ada_clear_symbol_cache (); 14143 } 14144 14145 void 14146 _initialize_ada_language (void) 14147 { 14148 add_language (&ada_language_defn); 14149 14150 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (); 14151 14152 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, set_ada_command, 14153 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specfic settings"), 14154 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist); 14155 14156 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, show_ada_command, 14157 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."), 14158 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist); 14159 14160 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure, 14161 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\ 14162 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types"), _("\ 14163 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated"), 14164 _("\ 14165 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\ 14166 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\ 14167 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\ 14168 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\ 14169 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\ 14170 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\ 14171 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."), 14172 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list); 14173 14174 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("print-signatures", class_vars, 14175 &print_signatures, _("\ 14176 Enable or disable the output of formal and return types for functions in the \ 14177 overloads selection menu"), _("\ 14178 Show whether the output of formal and return types for functions in the \ 14179 overloads selection menu is activated"), 14180 NULL, NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list); 14181 14182 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\ 14183 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\ 14184 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."), 14185 catch_ada_exception_command, 14186 NULL, 14187 CATCH_PERMANENT, 14188 CATCH_TEMPORARY); 14189 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\ 14190 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\ 14191 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."), 14192 catch_assert_command, 14193 NULL, 14194 CATCH_PERMANENT, 14195 CATCH_TEMPORARY); 14196 14197 varsize_limit = 65536; 14198 14199 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command, 14200 _("\ 14201 List all Ada exception names.\n\ 14202 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\ 14203 the regular expression are listed.")); 14204 14205 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_set_ada_cmd, 14206 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."), 14207 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ", 14208 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist); 14209 14210 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_show_ada_cmd, 14211 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables"), 14212 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ", 14213 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist); 14214 14215 add_setshow_boolean_cmd 14216 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance, 14217 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p, 14218 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."), 14219 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."), 14220 _("\ 14221 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\ 14222 DWARF attribute."), 14223 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist); 14224 14225 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack); 14226 14227 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc 14228 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq, 14229 NULL, xcalloc, xfree); 14230 14231 /* The ada-lang observers. */ 14232 observer_attach_new_objfile (ada_new_objfile_observer); 14233 observer_attach_free_objfile (ada_free_objfile_observer); 14234 observer_attach_inferior_exit (ada_inferior_exit); 14235 14236 /* Setup various context-specific data. */ 14237 ada_inferior_data 14238 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_inferior_data_cleanup); 14239 ada_pspace_data_handle 14240 = register_program_space_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_pspace_data_cleanup); 14241 } 14242